1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
2 //
3 //                     The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4 //
5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7 //
8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9 //
10 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11 //
12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13 
14 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
22 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
23 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h"
24 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
28 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
29 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
30 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
31 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
32 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
33 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
34 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
35 #include <algorithm>
36 #include <cstdlib>
37 
38 using namespace clang;
39 using namespace sema;
40 
41 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
42 static ExprResult
43 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
44                       bool HadMultipleCandidates,
45                       SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
46                       const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
47   if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc))
48     return ExprError();
49   // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template
50   // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
51   // called on both.
52   // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
53   // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
54   // being used.
55   if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc))
56     return ExprError();
57   DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, false, Fn->getType(),
58                                                  VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
59   if (HadMultipleCandidates)
60     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
61 
62   S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
63 
64   ExprResult E = DRE;
65   E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.get());
66   if (E.isInvalid())
67     return ExprError();
68   return E;
69 }
70 
71 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
72                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
73                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
74                                  bool CStyle,
75                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
76 
77 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
78                                                  QualType &ToType,
79                                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
80                                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
81                                                  bool CStyle);
82 static OverloadingResult
83 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
84                         UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
85                         OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
86                         bool AllowExplicit,
87                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
88 
89 
90 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
91 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
92                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
93                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
94 
95 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
96 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
97                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
98                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
99 
100 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
101 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
102                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
103                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
104 
105 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
106 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
107 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
108   static const ImplicitConversionRank
109     Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
110     ICR_Exact_Match,
111     ICR_Exact_Match,
112     ICR_Exact_Match,
113     ICR_Exact_Match,
114     ICR_Exact_Match,
115     ICR_Exact_Match,
116     ICR_Promotion,
117     ICR_Promotion,
118     ICR_Promotion,
119     ICR_Conversion,
120     ICR_Conversion,
121     ICR_Conversion,
122     ICR_Conversion,
123     ICR_Conversion,
124     ICR_Conversion,
125     ICR_Conversion,
126     ICR_Conversion,
127     ICR_Conversion,
128     ICR_Conversion,
129     ICR_Conversion,
130     ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
131     ICR_Conversion,
132     ICR_Conversion,
133     ICR_Writeback_Conversion,
134     ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right --
135                      // it was omitted by the patch that added
136                      // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion
137     ICR_C_Conversion
138   };
139   return Rank[(int)Kind];
140 }
141 
142 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
143 /// implicit conversion.
144 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
145   static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
146     "No conversion",
147     "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
148     "Array-to-pointer",
149     "Function-to-pointer",
150     "Noreturn adjustment",
151     "Qualification",
152     "Integral promotion",
153     "Floating point promotion",
154     "Complex promotion",
155     "Integral conversion",
156     "Floating conversion",
157     "Complex conversion",
158     "Floating-integral conversion",
159     "Pointer conversion",
160     "Pointer-to-member conversion",
161     "Boolean conversion",
162     "Compatible-types conversion",
163     "Derived-to-base conversion",
164     "Vector conversion",
165     "Vector splat",
166     "Complex-real conversion",
167     "Block Pointer conversion",
168     "Transparent Union Conversion",
169     "Writeback conversion",
170     "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion",
171     "C specific type conversion"
172   };
173   return Name[Kind];
174 }
175 
176 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
177 /// sequence to the identity conversion.
178 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
179   First = ICK_Identity;
180   Second = ICK_Identity;
181   Third = ICK_Identity;
182   DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
183   QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
184   ReferenceBinding = false;
185   DirectBinding = false;
186   IsLvalueReference = true;
187   BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
188   BindsToRvalue = false;
189   BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
190   ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
191   CopyConstructor = nullptr;
192 }
193 
194 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
195 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
196 /// implicit conversions.
197 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
198   ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
199   if  (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
200     Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
201   if  (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
202     Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
203   if  (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
204     Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
205   return Rank;
206 }
207 
208 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
209 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
210 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
211 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
212 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
213   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
214   // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
215   // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
216   // a pointer.
217   if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
218       (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
219        getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
220        getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
221        getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
222        First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
223     return true;
224 
225   return false;
226 }
227 
228 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
229 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
230 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
231 /// 13.3.3.2p4).
232 bool
233 StandardConversionSequence::
234 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
235   QualType FromType = getFromType();
236   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
237 
238   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
239   // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
240   // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
241   if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
242     FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
243 
244   if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
245     if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
246       return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
247 
248   return false;
249 }
250 
251 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
252 /// or after one in an implicit conversion.
253 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(const Expr *Converted) {
254   while (const ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
255     switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
256     case CK_NoOp:
257     case CK_IntegralCast:
258     case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
259     case CK_IntegralToFloating:
260     case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
261     case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
262     case CK_FloatingCast:
263       Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
264       continue;
265 
266     default:
267       return Converted;
268     }
269   }
270 
271   return Converted;
272 }
273 
274 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
275 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
276 ///
277 /// \param Ctx  The AST context.
278 /// \param Converted  The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
279 /// \param ConstantValue  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
280 ///        value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
281 /// \param ConstantType  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
282 ///        type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
283 NarrowingKind
284 StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(ASTContext &Ctx,
285                                              const Expr *Converted,
286                                              APValue &ConstantValue,
287                                              QualType &ConstantType) const {
288   assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
289 
290   // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
291   //   A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
292   QualType FromType = getToType(0);
293   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
294   switch (Second) {
295   // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it.
296   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
297     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType())
298       goto FloatingIntegralConversion;
299     if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
300       goto IntegralConversion;
301     // Boolean conversions can be from pointers and pointers to members
302     // [conv.bool], and those aren't considered narrowing conversions.
303     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
304 
305   // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
306   //
307   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
308   //    type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
309   //    value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
310   //    the original value when converted back to the original type, or
311   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
312   FloatingIntegralConversion:
313     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
314       return NK_Type_Narrowing;
315     } else if (FromType->isIntegralType(Ctx) && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
316       llvm::APSInt IntConstantValue;
317       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
318       if (Initializer &&
319           Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(IntConstantValue, Ctx)) {
320         // Convert the integer to the floating type.
321         llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
322         Result.convertFromAPInt(IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue.isSigned(),
323                                 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
324         // And back.
325         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = IntConstantValue;
326         bool ignored;
327         Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
328                                 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
329         // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
330         if (IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
331           ConstantValue = APValue(IntConstantValue);
332           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
333           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
334         }
335       } else {
336         // Variables are always narrowings.
337         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
338       }
339     }
340     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
341 
342   // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
343   //    where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
344   //    conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
345   //    if it cannot be represented exactly), or
346   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
347     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
348         Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
349       // FromType is larger than ToType.
350       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
351       if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
352         // Constant!
353         assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
354         llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
355         // Convert the source value into the target type.
356         bool ignored;
357         llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
358           Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
359           llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
360         // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
361         // values that can be represented.
362         if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
363           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
364           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
365         }
366       } else {
367         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
368       }
369     }
370     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
371 
372   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
373   //    that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
374   //    the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
375   //    conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
376   //    value when converted back to the original type.
377   case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
378   IntegralConversion: {
379     assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
380     assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
381     const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
382     const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
383     const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
384     const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
385 
386     if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
387         (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
388         (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
389       // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
390       llvm::APSInt InitializerValue;
391       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Converted);
392       if (!Initializer->isIntegerConstantExpr(InitializerValue, Ctx)) {
393         // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
394         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
395       }
396       bool Narrowing = false;
397       if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
398         // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
399         // narrowing.
400         if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
401           Narrowing = true;
402       } else {
403         // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
404         // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
405         InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
406           InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
407         // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
408         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
409         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
410         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
411         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
412         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
413         // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
414         if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
415           Narrowing = true;
416       }
417       if (Narrowing) {
418         ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
419         ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
420         return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
421       }
422     }
423     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
424   }
425 
426   default:
427     // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
428     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
429   }
430 }
431 
432 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
433 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
434 void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const {
435   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
436   bool PrintedSomething = false;
437   if (First != ICK_Identity) {
438     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
439     PrintedSomething = true;
440   }
441 
442   if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
443     if (PrintedSomething) {
444       OS << " -> ";
445     }
446     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
447 
448     if (CopyConstructor) {
449       OS << " (by copy constructor)";
450     } else if (DirectBinding) {
451       OS << " (direct reference binding)";
452     } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
453       OS << " (reference binding)";
454     }
455     PrintedSomething = true;
456   }
457 
458   if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
459     if (PrintedSomething) {
460       OS << " -> ";
461     }
462     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
463     PrintedSomething = true;
464   }
465 
466   if (!PrintedSomething) {
467     OS << "No conversions required";
468   }
469 }
470 
471 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
472 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
473 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const {
474   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
475   if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
476     Before.dump();
477     OS << " -> ";
478   }
479   if (ConversionFunction)
480     OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
481   else
482     OS << "aggregate initialization";
483   if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
484     OS << " -> ";
485     After.dump();
486   }
487 }
488 
489 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
490 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
491 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const {
492   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
493   if (isStdInitializerListElement())
494     OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: ";
495   switch (ConversionKind) {
496   case StandardConversion:
497     OS << "Standard conversion: ";
498     Standard.dump();
499     break;
500   case UserDefinedConversion:
501     OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
502     UserDefined.dump();
503     break;
504   case EllipsisConversion:
505     OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
506     break;
507   case AmbiguousConversion:
508     OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
509     break;
510   case BadConversion:
511     OS << "Bad conversion";
512     break;
513   }
514 
515   OS << "\n";
516 }
517 
518 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
519   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
520 }
521 
522 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
523   conversions().~ConversionSet();
524 }
525 
526 void
527 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
528   FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
529   ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
530   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
531 }
532 
533 namespace {
534   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
535   // template argument information.
536   struct DFIArguments {
537     TemplateArgument FirstArg;
538     TemplateArgument SecondArg;
539   };
540   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
541   // template parameter and template argument information.
542   struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
543     TemplateParameter Param;
544   };
545 }
546 
547 /// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
548 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
549 DeductionFailureInfo
550 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
551                                 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
552                                 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
553   DeductionFailureInfo Result;
554   Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
555   Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
556   Result.Data = nullptr;
557   switch (TDK) {
558   case Sema::TDK_Success:
559   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
560   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
561   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
562   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
563     break;
564 
565   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
566   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
567     Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
568     break;
569 
570   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
571     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
572     DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
573     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
574     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
575     Result.Data = Saved;
576     break;
577   }
578 
579   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
580   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
581     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
582     DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
583     Saved->Param = Info.Param;
584     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
585     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
586     Result.Data = Saved;
587     break;
588   }
589 
590   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
591     Result.Data = Info.take();
592     if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
593       PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
594           SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
595       Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
596       Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
597     }
598     break;
599 
600   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
601     Result.Data = Info.Expression;
602     break;
603 
604   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
605     break;
606   }
607 
608   return Result;
609 }
610 
611 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
612   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
613   case Sema::TDK_Success:
614   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
615   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
616   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
617   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
618   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
619   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
620   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
621     break;
622 
623   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
624   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
625   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
626     // FIXME: Destroy the data?
627     Data = nullptr;
628     break;
629 
630   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
631     // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
632     Data = nullptr;
633     if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
634       Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
635       HasDiagnostic = false;
636     }
637     break;
638 
639   // Unhandled
640   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
641     break;
642   }
643 }
644 
645 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
646   if (HasDiagnostic)
647     return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
648   return nullptr;
649 }
650 
651 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
652   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
653   case Sema::TDK_Success:
654   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
655   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
656   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
657   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
658   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
659   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
660   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
661     return TemplateParameter();
662 
663   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
664   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
665     return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
666 
667   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
668   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
669     return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
670 
671   // Unhandled
672   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
673     break;
674   }
675 
676   return TemplateParameter();
677 }
678 
679 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
680   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
681   case Sema::TDK_Success:
682   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
683   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
684   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
685   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
686   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
687   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
688   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
689   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
690   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
691   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
692     return nullptr;
693 
694   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
695     return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
696 
697   // Unhandled
698   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
699     break;
700   }
701 
702   return nullptr;
703 }
704 
705 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
706   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
707   case Sema::TDK_Success:
708   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
709   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
710   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
711   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
712   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
713   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
714   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
715   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
716     return nullptr;
717 
718   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
719   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
720   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
721     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
722 
723   // Unhandled
724   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
725     break;
726   }
727 
728   return nullptr;
729 }
730 
731 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
732   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
733   case Sema::TDK_Success:
734   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
735   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
736   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
737   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
738   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
739   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
740   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
741   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
742     return nullptr;
743 
744   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
745   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
746   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
747     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
748 
749   // Unhandled
750   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
751     break;
752   }
753 
754   return nullptr;
755 }
756 
757 Expr *DeductionFailureInfo::getExpr() {
758   if (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result) ==
759         Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution)
760     return static_cast<Expr*>(Data);
761 
762   return nullptr;
763 }
764 
765 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
766   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
767     for (unsigned ii = 0, ie = i->NumConversions; ii != ie; ++ii)
768       i->Conversions[ii].~ImplicitConversionSequence();
769     if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
770       i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
771   }
772 }
773 
774 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
775   destroyCandidates();
776   NumInlineSequences = 0;
777   Candidates.clear();
778   Functions.clear();
779 }
780 
781 namespace {
782   class UnbridgedCastsSet {
783     struct Entry {
784       Expr **Addr;
785       Expr *Saved;
786     };
787     SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
788 
789   public:
790     void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
791       assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
792       Entry entry = { &E, E };
793       Entries.push_back(entry);
794       E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
795     }
796 
797     void restore() {
798       for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
799              i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
800         *i->Addr = i->Saved;
801     }
802   };
803 }
804 
805 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
806 /// preprocessing on the given expression.
807 ///
808 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
809 ///   without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
810 ///
811 /// Return true on unrecoverable error.
812 static bool
813 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
814                             UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) {
815   if (const BuiltinType *placeholder =  E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
816     // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
817     // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
818     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
819 
820     // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
821     // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
822     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
823         unbridgedCasts) {
824       unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
825       return false;
826     }
827 
828     // Go ahead and check everything else.
829     ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
830     if (result.isInvalid())
831       return true;
832 
833     E = result.get();
834     return false;
835   }
836 
837   // Nothing to do.
838   return false;
839 }
840 
841 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
842 /// placeholders.
843 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S,
844                                             MultiExprArg Args,
845                                             UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
846   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
847     if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged))
848       return true;
849 
850   return false;
851 }
852 
853 // IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
854 // overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
855 // New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
856 // signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
857 // declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
858 // it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
859 // cannot be overloaded with.  This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
860 // top of the underlying declaration.
861 //
862 // Example: Given the following input:
863 //
864 //   void f(int, float); // #1
865 //   void f(int, int); // #2
866 //   int f(int, int); // #3
867 //
868 // When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
869 // so IsOverload will not be used.
870 //
871 // When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1.  By
872 // comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
873 // (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
874 // false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
875 //
876 // When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
877 // compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
878 // nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
879 // identical (return types of functions are not part of the
880 // signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
881 // point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
882 //
883 // 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
884 // into a class by a using declaration.  The rules for whether to hide
885 // shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
886 // into a function template's signature.
887 Sema::OverloadKind
888 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
889                     NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
890   for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
891          I != E; ++I) {
892     NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
893 
894     bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
895     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
896       OldIsUsingDecl = true;
897 
898       // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
899       // context, even if they have identical signatures.
900       if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
901 
902       OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
903     }
904 
905     // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration
906     // if one of them is hidden.
907     if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I))
908       continue;
909 
910     // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
911     // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
912     // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
913     // function templates hide function templates with different
914     // return types or template parameter lists.
915     bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
916       (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() &&
917       !New->getFriendObjectKind();
918 
919     if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) {
920       if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
921         if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
922           HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
923           continue;
924         }
925 
926         if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) &&
927             !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New))
928           continue;
929 
930         Match = *I;
931         return Ovl_Match;
932       }
933     } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
934       // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
935       // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
936       assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
937     } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
938       // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
939     } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
940       // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
941       // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
942       // template instantiation.
943     } else {
944       // (C++ 13p1):
945       //   Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
946       //   declarations cannot be overloaded.
947       Match = *I;
948       return Ovl_NonFunction;
949     }
950   }
951 
952   return Ovl_Overload;
953 }
954 
955 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
956                       bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
957   // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded.
958   if (New->isMain())
959     return false;
960 
961   // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded.
962   if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
963     return false;
964 
965   FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
966   FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
967 
968   // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
969   //   A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
970   //   and with normal (non-template) functions.
971   if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr))
972     return true;
973 
974   // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
975   QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
976   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
977 
978   // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
979   // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
980   // in the signature, they are overloads.
981 
982   // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
983   // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
984   if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
985       isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
986     return false;
987 
988   const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
989   const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
990 
991   // The signature of a function includes the types of its
992   // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
993   // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
994   if (OldQType != NewQType &&
995       (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() ||
996        OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
997        !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
998     return true;
999 
1000   // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1001   //   The signature of a function template consists of its function
1002   //   signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1003   //   of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1004   //   relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1005   //   signature.
1006   //
1007   // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1008   // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
1009   //
1010   // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1011   // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1012   if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
1013       (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1014                                        OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1015                                        false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
1016        OldType->getReturnType() != NewType->getReturnType()))
1017     return true;
1018 
1019   // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
1020   // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
1021   //
1022   // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1023   // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1024   // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1025   // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1026   // can be overloaded.
1027   CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1028   CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
1029   if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
1030       !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1031     if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1032       if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
1033           (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1034            NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1035         // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1036         //   - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1037         //     parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1038         //     declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1039         //     the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1040         //     them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
1041         Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
1042           << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
1043         Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1044       }
1045       return true;
1046     }
1047 
1048     // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1049     // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1050     // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1051     // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
1052     unsigned OldQuals = OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
1053     unsigned NewQuals = NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers();
1054     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() &&
1055         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
1056       NewQuals |= Qualifiers::Const;
1057 
1058     // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'.
1059     OldQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict;
1060     NewQuals &= ~Qualifiers::Restrict;
1061     if (OldQuals != NewQuals)
1062       return true;
1063   }
1064 
1065   // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature.
1066   for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr>
1067          NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1068          NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(),
1069          OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1070          OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>();
1071        NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) {
1072     if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE)
1073       return true;
1074     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1075     NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true);
1076     OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true);
1077     if (NewID != OldID)
1078       return true;
1079   }
1080 
1081   if (getLangOpts().CUDA && getLangOpts().CUDATargetOverloads) {
1082     CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New),
1083                        OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old);
1084     if (NewTarget == CFT_InvalidTarget || NewTarget == CFT_Global)
1085       return false;
1086 
1087     assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) && "Unexpected invalid target.");
1088 
1089     // Don't allow mixing of HD with other kinds. This guarantees that
1090     // we have only one viable function with this signature on any
1091     // side of CUDA compilation .
1092     if ((NewTarget == CFT_HostDevice) || (OldTarget == CFT_HostDevice))
1093       return false;
1094 
1095     // Allow overloading of functions with same signature, but
1096     // different CUDA target attributes.
1097     return NewTarget != OldTarget;
1098   }
1099 
1100   // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1101   return false;
1102 }
1103 
1104 /// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
1105 /// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
1106 ///
1107 /// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
1108 /// an available function, false otherwise.
1109 bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
1110   return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
1111 }
1112 
1113 /// \brief Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1114 ///
1115 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1116 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1117 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1118 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1119                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
1120                          bool AllowExplicit,
1121                          bool InOverloadResolution,
1122                          bool CStyle,
1123                          bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1124                          bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1125   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1126 
1127   if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1128     // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1129     // we can perform.
1130     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1131     return ICS;
1132   }
1133 
1134   // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1135   OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(),
1136                                    OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
1137   switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
1138                                   Conversions, AllowExplicit,
1139                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) {
1140   case OR_Success:
1141   case OR_Deleted:
1142     ICS.setUserDefined();
1143     ICS.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
1144     // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1145     //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1146     //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1147     //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1148     //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1149     //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1150     //   called for those cases.
1151     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1152           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1153       QualType FromCanon
1154         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1155       QualType ToCanon
1156         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1157       if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1158           (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1159         // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1160         // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1161         ICS.setStandard();
1162         ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1163         ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1164         ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1165         ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1166         if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1167           ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1168       }
1169     }
1170     break;
1171 
1172   case OR_Ambiguous:
1173     ICS.setAmbiguous();
1174     ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1175     ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1176     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1177          Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1178       if (Cand->Viable)
1179         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
1180     break;
1181 
1182     // Fall through.
1183   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
1184     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1185     break;
1186   }
1187 
1188   return ICS;
1189 }
1190 
1191 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1192 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1193 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1194 /// to perform the initialization. Given
1195 ///
1196 ///   void f(float f);
1197 ///   void g(int i) { f(i); }
1198 ///
1199 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1200 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1201 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1202 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1203 //
1204 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1205 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1206 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1207 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1208 /// "BadConversion".
1209 ///
1210 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1211 /// not permitted.
1212 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1213 /// permitted.
1214 ///
1215 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1216 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1217 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
1218 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1219 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1220                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
1221                       bool AllowExplicit,
1222                       bool InOverloadResolution,
1223                       bool CStyle,
1224                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1225                       bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1226   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1227   if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1228                            ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
1229     ICS.setStandard();
1230     return ICS;
1231   }
1232 
1233   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1234     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1235     return ICS;
1236   }
1237 
1238   // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1239   //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1240   //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1241   //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1242   //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1243   //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1244   //   called for those cases.
1245   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1246   if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
1247       (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1248        S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
1249     ICS.setStandard();
1250     ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1251     ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1252     ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1253 
1254     // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1255     // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1256     // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1257     // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1258     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1259 
1260     // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
1261     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1262       ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1263 
1264     return ICS;
1265   }
1266 
1267   return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1268                                   AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1269                                   AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1270                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
1271 }
1272 
1273 ImplicitConversionSequence
1274 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1275                             bool SuppressUserConversions,
1276                             bool AllowExplicit,
1277                             bool InOverloadResolution,
1278                             bool CStyle,
1279                             bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1280   return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1281                                  SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
1282                                  InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1283                                  AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1284                                  /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1285 }
1286 
1287 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
1288 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
1289 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1290 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1291 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
1292 ExprResult
1293 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1294                                 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
1295   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1296   return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
1297 }
1298 
1299 ExprResult
1300 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1301                                 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
1302                                 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
1303   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1304     return ExprError();
1305 
1306   // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1307   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
1308     = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
1309       (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
1310   if (getLangOpts().ObjC1)
1311     CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getLocStart(),
1312                                       ToType, From->getType(), From);
1313   ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1314                                 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1315                                 AllowExplicit,
1316                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
1317                                 /*CStyle=*/false,
1318                                 AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1319                                 /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1320   return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1321 }
1322 
1323 /// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1324 /// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
1325 bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1326                                 QualType &ResultTy) {
1327   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1328     return false;
1329 
1330   // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1331   // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1332   //   - a pointer
1333   //   - a member pointer
1334   //   - a block pointer
1335   CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1336   CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1337   Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1338   if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1339   if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1340     if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1341       CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1342       CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1343     } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1344       CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1345       CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1346     } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1347       CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1348       CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1349     } else {
1350       return false;
1351     }
1352 
1353     TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1354     if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1355     if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1356       return false;
1357   }
1358 
1359   const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1360   FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1361   if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1362 
1363   FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1364   assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1365   if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1366 
1367   ResultTy = ToType;
1368   return true;
1369 }
1370 
1371 /// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1372 /// vector conversion.
1373 ///
1374 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1375 /// conversion.
1376 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
1377                                QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
1378   // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1379   // conversion.
1380   if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1381     return false;
1382 
1383   // Identical types require no conversions.
1384   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1385     return false;
1386 
1387   // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1388   if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1389     // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1390     // identity conversion.
1391     if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1392       return false;
1393 
1394     // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
1395     if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
1396       ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1397       return true;
1398     }
1399   }
1400 
1401   // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1402   // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1403   // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1404   //   same size
1405   if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1406     if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1407         S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType)) {
1408       ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1409       return true;
1410     }
1411   }
1412 
1413   return false;
1414 }
1415 
1416 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1417                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
1418                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1419                                 bool CStyle);
1420 
1421 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1422 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1423 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1424 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1425 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1426 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1427 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1428 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
1429 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1430                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
1431                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1432                                  bool CStyle,
1433                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1434   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1435 
1436   // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
1437   SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
1438   SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
1439   SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1440   SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1441 
1442   // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
1443   // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them.
1444   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1445       (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()))
1446     return false;
1447 
1448   // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1449   // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1450   // (C++ 4p1).
1451 
1452   if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1453     DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1454     if (FunctionDecl *Fn
1455           = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
1456                                                  AccessPair)) {
1457       // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1458       // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1459       FromType = Fn->getType();
1460       SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1461 
1462       // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1463       // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1464       if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1465                       S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1466         QualType resultTy;
1467         // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
1468         if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
1469               S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1470           // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1471           if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1472             return false;
1473       }
1474 
1475       // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1476       // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1477       // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1478       // expression.
1479       CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1480       if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1481         assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1482                "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1483         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1484                == UO_AddrOf &&
1485                "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1486         const Type *ClassType
1487           = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1488         FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
1489       } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1490         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1491                UO_AddrOf &&
1492                "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1493         FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1494       }
1495 
1496       // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
1497       assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1498         FromType,
1499         S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
1500     } else {
1501       return false;
1502     }
1503   }
1504   // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1505   //   A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1506   //   be converted to a prvalue.
1507   bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
1508   if (argIsLValue &&
1509       !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
1510       S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1511     SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
1512 
1513     // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1514     //   ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1515     //   of the type of the lvalue ...
1516     if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1517       FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1518 
1519     // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1520     // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
1521     // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1522     // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
1523     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1524   } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1525     // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
1526     SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
1527 
1528     // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1529     // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1530     // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
1531     FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
1532 
1533     if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
1534       // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4)
1535       SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
1536 
1537       // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1538       // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1539       // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1540       // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
1541       SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1542       SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1543       SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
1544       SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
1545       return true;
1546     }
1547   } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
1548     // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
1549     SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
1550 
1551     // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1552     // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1553     // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
1554     FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1555   } else {
1556     // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
1557     SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
1558   }
1559   SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
1560 
1561   // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1562   // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1563   // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1564   // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
1565   // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1566   // conversion.
1567   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
1568   ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
1569   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
1570     // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1571     // conversion to do.
1572     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1573   } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
1574     // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
1575     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
1576     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1577   } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1578     // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
1579     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
1580     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1581   } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1582     // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
1583     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1584     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1585   } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1586              (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1587               FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1588               FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1589               FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1590               FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1591     // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1592     SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1593     FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
1594   } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1595              ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
1596     // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
1597     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
1598     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1599   } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) {
1600     // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
1601     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1602     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1603   } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1604              (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
1605     // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1606     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1607     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1608   } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
1609     // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1610     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1611     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1612   } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
1613               ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
1614              (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1615               ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
1616     // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
1617     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
1618     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1619   } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1620     SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1621   } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1622              S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1623     SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
1624   } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1625                                    FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1626     // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
1627     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
1628     SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
1629     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1630   } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
1631                                          InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
1632     // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
1633     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
1634   } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
1635     SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1636     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1637   } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1638              S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
1639     // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
1640     SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
1641     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1642   } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1643     // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1644     SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
1645   } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1646                                              InOverloadResolution,
1647                                              SCS, CStyle)) {
1648     SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1649     FromType = ToType;
1650   } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1651                                  CStyle)) {
1652     // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
1653     // appropriately.
1654     return true;
1655   } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1656              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1657              From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) {
1658     SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1659     FromType = ToType;
1660   } else {
1661     // No second conversion required.
1662     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1663   }
1664   SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
1665 
1666   QualType CanonFrom;
1667   QualType CanonTo;
1668   // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
1669   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1670   if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1671                                   ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
1672     SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1673     SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1674     FromType = ToType;
1675     CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1676     CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1677   } else {
1678     // No conversion required
1679     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1680 
1681     // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
1682     //   [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1683     //   subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1684     //   a conversion. [...]
1685     CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1686     CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1687     if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
1688                                        == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
1689         CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
1690       FromType = ToType;
1691       CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1692     }
1693   }
1694   SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
1695 
1696   if (CanonFrom == CanonTo)
1697     return true;
1698 
1699   // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1700   // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C.
1701   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution)
1702     return false;
1703 
1704   ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From};
1705   auto Conv = S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER,
1706                                                  /*Diagnose=*/false,
1707                                                  /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false,
1708                                                  /*ConvertRHS=*/false);
1709   if (Conv != Sema::Compatible)
1710     return false;
1711 
1712   SCS.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1713   // We need to set all three because we want this conversion to rank terribly,
1714   // and we don't know what conversions it may overlap with.
1715   SCS.First = ICK_C_Only_Conversion;
1716   SCS.Second = ICK_C_Only_Conversion;
1717   SCS.Third = ICK_C_Only_Conversion;
1718   return true;
1719 }
1720 
1721 static bool
1722 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1723                                      QualType &ToType,
1724                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
1725                                      StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1726                                      bool CStyle) {
1727 
1728   const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1729   if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1730     return false;
1731   // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1732   RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1733   // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1734   for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) {
1735     if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1736                              CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
1737       ToType = it->getType();
1738       return true;
1739     }
1740   }
1741   return false;
1742 }
1743 
1744 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1745 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1746 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1747 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
1748 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
1749   const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
1750   // All integers are built-in.
1751   if (!To) {
1752     return false;
1753   }
1754 
1755   // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1756   // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1757   // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1758   // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1759   // int (C++ 4.5p1).
1760   if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1761       !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
1762     if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1763         (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1764          // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1765          // less than int to an int.
1766          (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
1767           Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
1768       return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1769     }
1770 
1771     return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1772   }
1773 
1774   // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
1775   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1776   //   fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1777   //   following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1778   //   (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1779   //   unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
1780   //   long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
1781   //   values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
1782   //   type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
1783   //   with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1784   //   long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
1785   //   there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
1786   // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
1787   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
1788   //   can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
1789   //   integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
1790   //   unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
1791   //   converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
1792   if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1793     // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1794     // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1795     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1796       return false;
1797 
1798     // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
1799     // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting
1800     // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider
1801     // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression.
1802     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
1803       QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
1804       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
1805              IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType);
1806     }
1807 
1808     // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
1809     if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
1810         !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, 0))
1811       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1812           ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
1813   }
1814 
1815   // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
1816   //   A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1817   //   to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1818   //   represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
1819   //   long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
1820   //   If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
1821   //   underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
1822   //   or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
1823   //   type.
1824   if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
1825       ToType->isIntegerType()) {
1826     // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1827     // unsigned.
1828     bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
1829     uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
1830 
1831     // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1832     // order. Try each of these types.
1833     QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1834       Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
1835       Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1836       Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
1837     };
1838     for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
1839       uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1840       if (FromSize < ToSize ||
1841           (FromSize == ToSize &&
1842            FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1843         // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1844         // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1845         // promotion.
1846         return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1847       }
1848     }
1849   }
1850 
1851   // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1852   // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1853   // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1854   // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1855   // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1856   // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1857   // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
1858   // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1859   // conversion.
1860   if (From) {
1861     if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) {
1862       llvm::APSInt BitWidth;
1863       if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
1864           MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1865         llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1866         ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
1867 
1868         // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1869         if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1870             (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1871           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1872         }
1873 
1874         // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1875         // that fits into an unsigned int?
1876         if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1877           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1878         }
1879 
1880         return false;
1881       }
1882     }
1883   }
1884 
1885   // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1886   // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
1887   if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
1888     return true;
1889   }
1890 
1891   return false;
1892 }
1893 
1894 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1895 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1896 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
1897 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
1898   if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1899     if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
1900       /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1901       /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
1902       if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1903           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1904         return true;
1905 
1906       // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1907       //   When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1908       //   double is promoted to long double [...].
1909       if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1910           (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1911            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1912           (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1913         return true;
1914 
1915       // Half can be promoted to float.
1916       if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
1917            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
1918           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1919         return true;
1920     }
1921 
1922   return false;
1923 }
1924 
1925 /// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1926 ///
1927 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1928 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
1929 /// floating-point or integral promotion.
1930 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
1931   const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
1932   if (!FromComplex)
1933     return false;
1934 
1935   const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
1936   if (!ToComplex)
1937     return false;
1938 
1939   return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
1940                                   ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1941     IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1942                         ToComplex->getElementType());
1943 }
1944 
1945 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1946 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1947 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1948 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1949 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
1950 ///
1951 static QualType
1952 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
1953                                    QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
1954                                    ASTContext &Context,
1955                                    bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
1956   assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1957           FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1958          "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
1959 
1960   /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1961   if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
1962     return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1963 
1964   QualType CanonFromPointee
1965     = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
1966   QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
1967   Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
1968 
1969   if (StripObjCLifetime)
1970     Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1971 
1972   // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
1973   if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
1974     // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
1975     if (!ToType.isNull())
1976       return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1977 
1978     // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1979     // already.
1980     if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1981       return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
1982     return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1983   }
1984 
1985   // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
1986   QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1987     = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
1988 
1989   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1990     return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1991   return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1992 }
1993 
1994 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
1995                                                bool InOverloadResolution,
1996                                                ASTContext &Context) {
1997   // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1998   // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1999   if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
2000       Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
2001     return !InOverloadResolution;
2002 
2003   return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2004                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2005                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
2006 }
2007 
2008 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2009 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
2010 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
2011 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
2012 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
2013 /// ConvertedType.
2014 ///
2015 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
2016 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
2017 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
2018 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
2019 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
2020 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
2021 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
2022 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
2023 /// should result in a warning.
2024 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2025                                bool InOverloadResolution,
2026                                QualType& ConvertedType,
2027                                bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2028   IncompatibleObjC = false;
2029   if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
2030                               IncompatibleObjC))
2031     return true;
2032 
2033   // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2034   if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
2035       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2036     ConvertedType = ToType;
2037     return true;
2038   }
2039 
2040   // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2041   if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
2042       ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
2043     ConvertedType = ToType;
2044     return true;
2045   }
2046   // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2047   // pointer type.
2048   if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
2049       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2050     ConvertedType = ToType;
2051     return true;
2052   }
2053 
2054   // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2055   // pointer constant.
2056   if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
2057       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2058     ConvertedType = ToType;
2059     return true;
2060   }
2061 
2062   const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
2063   if (!ToTypePtr)
2064     return false;
2065 
2066   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
2067   if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2068     ConvertedType = ToType;
2069     return true;
2070   }
2071 
2072   // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
2073   // , including objective-c pointers.
2074   QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2075   if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
2076       !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
2077     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2078                                       FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2079                                                        ToPointeeType,
2080                                                        ToType, Context);
2081     return true;
2082   }
2083   const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
2084   if (!FromTypePtr)
2085     return false;
2086 
2087   QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2088 
2089   // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
2090   // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2091   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2092     return false;
2093 
2094   // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2095   // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2096   // 4.10p2).
2097   if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2098       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2099     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2100                                                        ToPointeeType,
2101                                                        ToType, Context,
2102                                                    /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
2103     return true;
2104   }
2105 
2106   // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
2107   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
2108       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2109     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2110                                                        ToPointeeType,
2111                                                        ToType, Context);
2112     return true;
2113   }
2114 
2115   // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2116   // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
2117   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2118       Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2119     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2120                                                        ToPointeeType,
2121                                                        ToType, Context);
2122     return true;
2123   }
2124 
2125   // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
2126   //
2127   //   An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2128   //   can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2129   //   B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2130   //   (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2131   //   necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2132   //   conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2133   //   derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2134   //   the null pointer value of the destination type.
2135   //
2136   // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2137   // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
2138   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2139       FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2140       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
2141       !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, 0) &&
2142       IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2143     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2144                                                        ToPointeeType,
2145                                                        ToType, Context);
2146     return true;
2147   }
2148 
2149   if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2150       Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2151     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2152                                                        ToPointeeType,
2153                                                        ToType, Context);
2154     return true;
2155   }
2156 
2157   return false;
2158 }
2159 
2160 /// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2161 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2162   Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2163 
2164   // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2165   if (TQs == Qs)
2166     return T;
2167 
2168   if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2169     return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2170 
2171   return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2172 }
2173 
2174 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2175 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2176 /// with the same arguments and return values.
2177 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2178                                    QualType& ConvertedType,
2179                                    bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2180   if (!getLangOpts().ObjC1)
2181     return false;
2182 
2183   // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2184   Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2185 
2186   // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
2187   const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2188     ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2189   const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
2190     FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2191 
2192   if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
2193     // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2194     // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2195     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2196                                        FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2197       return false;
2198 
2199     // Conversion between Objective-C pointers.
2200     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
2201       const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2202       const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2203       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
2204           !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2205                                                 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2206         return false;
2207       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2208                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2209                                                          ToType, Context);
2210       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2211       return true;
2212     }
2213 
2214     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2215       // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2216       // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2217       // complain about it.
2218       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2219       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2220                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2221                                                          ToType, Context);
2222       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2223       return true;
2224     }
2225   }
2226   // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
2227   QualType ToPointeeType;
2228   if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2229     ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
2230   else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2231             ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
2232     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
2233     // to a block pointer type.
2234     if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2235       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2236       return true;
2237     }
2238     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2239   }
2240   else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
2241            ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2242     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
2243     // pointer to any object.
2244     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2245     return true;
2246   }
2247   else
2248     return false;
2249 
2250   QualType FromPointeeType;
2251   if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2252     FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
2253   else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2254            FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2255     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2256   else
2257     return false;
2258 
2259   // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2260   // is an Objective-C conversion.
2261   if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2262       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2263                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2264     // We always complain about this conversion.
2265     IncompatibleObjC = true;
2266     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2267     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2268     return true;
2269   }
2270   // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2271   // as in I* to id.
2272   if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2273       ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2274       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2275                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2276 
2277     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2278     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2279     return true;
2280   }
2281 
2282   // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
2283   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2284   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2285   // complain about it).
2286   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2287     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2288   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2289     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2290   if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2291     // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2292     // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2293     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2294           == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2295       return false;
2296 
2297     // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2298     // function types are obviously different.
2299     if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2300         FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2301         FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
2302       return false;
2303 
2304     bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2305     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) ==
2306         Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2307       // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2308     } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2309                                        ToFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2310                                        ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2311       // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2312       HasObjCConversion = true;
2313     } else {
2314       // Function types are too different. Abort.
2315       return false;
2316     }
2317 
2318     // Check argument types.
2319     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2320          ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2321       QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2322       QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2323       if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2324             == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2325         // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2326       } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2327                                          ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2328         // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2329         HasObjCConversion = true;
2330       } else {
2331         // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2332         return false;
2333       }
2334     }
2335 
2336     if (HasObjCConversion) {
2337       // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2338       // conversion, but complain about it.
2339       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2340       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2341       return true;
2342     }
2343   }
2344 
2345   return false;
2346 }
2347 
2348 /// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2349 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2350 ///
2351 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2352 ///
2353 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2354 ///
2355 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2356 /// this conversion.
2357 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2358                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
2359   if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
2360       Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2361     return false;
2362 
2363   // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2364   QualType ToPointee;
2365   if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2366     ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2367   else
2368     return false;
2369 
2370   Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2371   if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2372       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
2373       !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
2374     return false;
2375 
2376   // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2377   QualType FromPointee;
2378   if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2379     FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2380   else
2381     return false;
2382 
2383   Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2384   if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2385       (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2386        FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2387     return false;
2388 
2389   // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2390   FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2391   if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2392     return false;
2393 
2394   // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2395   // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2396   // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2397   FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2398 
2399   // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2400   ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2401   bool IncompatibleObjC;
2402   if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2403     FromPointee = ToPointee;
2404   else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2405                                     IncompatibleObjC))
2406     return false;
2407 
2408   /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2409   /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2410   FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2411   ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2412   return true;
2413 }
2414 
2415 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2416                                     QualType& ConvertedType) {
2417   QualType ToPointeeType;
2418   if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2419         ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2420     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2421   else
2422     return false;
2423 
2424   QualType FromPointeeType;
2425   if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2426       FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2427     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2428   else
2429     return false;
2430   // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2431   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2432   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2433 
2434   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2435     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2436   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2437     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2438 
2439   if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2440     return false;
2441 
2442   if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2443     return true;
2444 
2445   // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2446   // function types are obviously different.
2447   if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2448       FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2449     return false;
2450 
2451   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2452   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2453   if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2454     return false;
2455 
2456   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
2457   if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2458                           ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2459     // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2460   } else {
2461     QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType();
2462     QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType();
2463     if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2464         !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2465        LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2466 
2467      if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2468        // OK exact match.
2469      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2470                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2471      if (IncompatibleObjC)
2472        return false;
2473      // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2474      }
2475      else
2476        return false;
2477    }
2478 
2479    // Check argument types.
2480    for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2481         ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2482      IncompatibleObjC = false;
2483      QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2484      QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2485      if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2486        // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2487      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2488                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2489        if (IncompatibleObjC)
2490          return false;
2491        // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2492      } else
2493        // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2494        return false;
2495    }
2496    if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2497        !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2498                                                     ToFunctionType))
2499      return false;
2500 
2501    ConvertedType = ToType;
2502    return true;
2503 }
2504 
2505 enum {
2506   ft_default,
2507   ft_different_class,
2508   ft_parameter_arity,
2509   ft_parameter_mismatch,
2510   ft_return_type,
2511   ft_qualifer_mismatch,
2512   ft_addr_enable_if
2513 };
2514 
2515 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2516 /// function types.  Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2517 /// parameter types, and different return types.
2518 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2519                                       QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2520   // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2521   if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2522     PDiag << ft_default;
2523     return;
2524   }
2525 
2526   // Get the function type from the pointers.
2527   if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2528     const MemberPointerType *FromMember = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2529                             *ToMember = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2530     if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) {
2531       PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2532             << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2533       return;
2534     }
2535     FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2536     ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
2537   }
2538 
2539   if (FromType->isPointerType())
2540     FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2541   if (ToType->isPointerType())
2542     ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2543 
2544   // Remove references.
2545   FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2546   ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2547 
2548   // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2549   if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2550       !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2551     PDiag << ft_default;
2552     return;
2553   }
2554 
2555   // No extra info for same types.
2556   if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2557     PDiag << ft_default;
2558     return;
2559   }
2560 
2561   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(),
2562                           *ToFunction = ToType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2563 
2564   // Both types need to be function types.
2565   if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2566     PDiag << ft_default;
2567     return;
2568   }
2569 
2570   if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) {
2571     PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams()
2572           << FromFunction->getNumParams();
2573     return;
2574   }
2575 
2576   // Handle different parameter types.
2577   unsigned ArgPos;
2578   if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2579     PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2580           << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos)
2581           << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos);
2582     return;
2583   }
2584 
2585   // Handle different return type.
2586   if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(),
2587                            ToFunction->getReturnType())) {
2588     PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType()
2589           << FromFunction->getReturnType();
2590     return;
2591   }
2592 
2593   unsigned FromQuals = FromFunction->getTypeQuals(),
2594            ToQuals = ToFunction->getTypeQuals();
2595   if (FromQuals != ToQuals) {
2596     PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToQuals << FromQuals;
2597     return;
2598   }
2599 
2600   // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2601   PDiag << ft_default;
2602 }
2603 
2604 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
2605 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
2606 /// they have same number of arguments.  If the parameters are different,
2607 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter.
2608 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
2609                                       const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2610                                       unsigned *ArgPos) {
2611   for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(),
2612                                               N = NewType->param_type_begin(),
2613                                               E = OldType->param_type_end();
2614        O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2615     if (!Context.hasSameType(O->getUnqualifiedType(),
2616                              N->getUnqualifiedType())) {
2617       if (ArgPos)
2618         *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin();
2619       return false;
2620     }
2621   }
2622   return true;
2623 }
2624 
2625 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2626 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
2627 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
2628 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2629 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2630 /// error, or returns false otherwise.
2631 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2632                                   CastKind &Kind,
2633                                   CXXCastPath& BasePath,
2634                                   bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
2635   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2636   bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
2637 
2638   Kind = CK_BitCast;
2639 
2640   if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2641       From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2642       Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2643     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2644       DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2645                           PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2646                             << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2647     else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
2648       Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
2649         << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2650   }
2651   if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2652     if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2653       QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2654                ToPointeeType   = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
2655 
2656       if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2657           !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2658         // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2659         // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
2660         if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2661                                          From->getExprLoc(),
2662                                          From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
2663                                          IgnoreBaseAccess))
2664           return true;
2665 
2666         // The conversion was successful.
2667         Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
2668       }
2669 
2670       if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
2671           ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2672         assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
2673                "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!");
2674         Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj)
2675             << From->getSourceRange();
2676       }
2677     }
2678   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2679                ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2680     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2681           FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2682       // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2683       // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2684       // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
2685       if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
2686         return false;
2687     } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2688       Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2689     } else {
2690       Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2691     }
2692   } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2693     if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2694       Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
2695   }
2696 
2697   // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2698   // reasons.
2699   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2700     Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2701 
2702   return false;
2703 }
2704 
2705 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2706 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2707 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2708 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2709 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2710 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
2711                                      QualType ToType,
2712                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
2713                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
2714   const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2715   if (!ToTypePtr)
2716     return false;
2717 
2718   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
2719   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2720                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2721                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
2722     ConvertedType = ToType;
2723     return true;
2724   }
2725 
2726   // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
2727   const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2728   if (!FromTypePtr)
2729     return false;
2730 
2731   // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2732   // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2733   QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2734   QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2735 
2736   if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2737       !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, 0) &&
2738       IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
2739     ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2740                                                  ToClass.getTypePtr());
2741     return true;
2742   }
2743 
2744   return false;
2745 }
2746 
2747 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2748 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
2749 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
2750 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2751 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2752 /// otherwise.
2753 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2754                                         CastKind &Kind,
2755                                         CXXCastPath &BasePath,
2756                                         bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
2757   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2758   const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2759   if (!FromPtrType) {
2760     // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
2761     assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2762                                        Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
2763            "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
2764     Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
2765     return false;
2766   }
2767 
2768   const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2769   assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2770                       "that is not a member pointer.");
2771 
2772   QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2773   QualType ToClass   = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2774 
2775   // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2776   assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2777   assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2778 
2779   CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
2780                      /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
2781   bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2782   assert(DerivationOkay &&
2783          "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2784   (void)DerivationOkay;
2785 
2786   if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2787                                   getUnqualifiedType())) {
2788     std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2789     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2790       << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2791     return true;
2792   }
2793 
2794   if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
2795     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2796       << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2797       << From->getSourceRange();
2798     return true;
2799   }
2800 
2801   if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
2802     CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2803                          Paths.front(),
2804                          diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
2805 
2806   // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
2807   BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
2808   Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
2809   return false;
2810 }
2811 
2812 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given
2813 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial.
2814 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals,
2815                                                Qualifiers ToQuals) {
2816   // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial.
2817   if (ToQuals.hasConst() &&
2818       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone)
2819     return false;
2820 
2821   return true;
2822 }
2823 
2824 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2825 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2826 /// (C++ 4.4).
2827 ///
2828 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2829 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2830 /// object lifetime.
2831 bool
2832 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2833                                 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
2834   FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2835   ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
2836   ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2837 
2838   // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2839   // qualification conversion.
2840   if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
2841     return false;
2842 
2843   // (C++ 4.4p4):
2844   //   A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2845   //   in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2846   bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
2847   bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
2848   while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
2849     // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2850     // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2851     // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
2852     // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
2853     // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2854     // unwrap.
2855     UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
2856 
2857     Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2858     Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2859 
2860     // Objective-C ARC:
2861     //   Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2862     if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2863         UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2864       if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2865         if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals))
2866           ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2867         FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2868         ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2869       } else {
2870         // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2871         // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2872         return false;
2873       }
2874     }
2875 
2876     // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2877     if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2878         (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2879       FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2880       ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2881     }
2882 
2883     //   -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2884     //      2,j, and similarly for volatile.
2885     if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2886       return false;
2887 
2888     //   -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2889     //      every cv for 0 < k < j.
2890     if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
2891         && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
2892       return false;
2893 
2894     // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2895     // include const.
2896     PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
2897       = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
2898   }
2899 
2900   // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2901   // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2902   // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2903   // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2904   // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
2905   return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
2906 }
2907 
2908 /// \brief - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
2909 /// atomic type.
2910 ///
2911 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
2912 /// sequence to finish the conversion.
2913 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2914                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
2915                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2916                                 bool CStyle) {
2917   const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
2918   if (!ToAtomic)
2919     return false;
2920 
2921   StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
2922   if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
2923                             InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
2924                             CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
2925     return false;
2926 
2927   SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
2928   SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
2929   SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
2930   SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
2931     = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
2932   SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
2933   return true;
2934 }
2935 
2936 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
2937                                               CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
2938                                               QualType Type) {
2939   const FunctionProtoType *CtorType =
2940       Constructor->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2941   if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) {
2942     QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0);
2943     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
2944       return true;
2945   }
2946   return false;
2947 }
2948 
2949 static OverloadingResult
2950 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2951                                        CXXRecordDecl *To,
2952                                        UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
2953                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
2954                                        bool AllowExplicit) {
2955   DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(To);
2956   for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
2957        Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2958     NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2959     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2960 
2961     // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2962     CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = nullptr;
2963     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2964       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2965     if (ConstructorTmpl)
2966       Constructor
2967         = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2968     else
2969       Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2970 
2971     bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2972                   S.isInitListConstructor(Constructor) &&
2973                   (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
2974     if (Usable) {
2975       // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
2976       // suppress conversions.
2977       bool SuppressUserConversions =
2978           isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
2979       if (ConstructorTmpl)
2980         S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2981                                        /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr,
2982                                        From, CandidateSet,
2983                                        SuppressUserConversions);
2984       else
2985         S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
2986                                From, CandidateSet,
2987                                SuppressUserConversions);
2988     }
2989   }
2990 
2991   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2992 
2993   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2994   switch (auto Result =
2995             CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(),
2996                                             Best, true)) {
2997   case OR_Deleted:
2998   case OR_Success: {
2999     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3000     CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
3001     QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
3002     // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3003     User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3004     User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3005     User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3006     User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3007     User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3008     User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3009     User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3010     return Result;
3011   }
3012 
3013   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3014     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3015   case OR_Ambiguous:
3016     return OR_Ambiguous;
3017   }
3018 
3019   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3020 }
3021 
3022 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3023 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3024 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3025 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3026 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3027 /// false and User is unspecified.
3028 ///
3029 /// \param AllowExplicit  true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3030 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3031 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
3032 ///
3033 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should
3034 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit
3035 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set.
3036 static OverloadingResult
3037 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3038                         UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3039                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
3040                         bool AllowExplicit,
3041                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
3042   assert(AllowExplicit || !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3043 
3044   // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3045   bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3046 
3047   // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3048   // constructors.
3049   if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3050     // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3051     //   When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3052     //   copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3053     //   derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3054     //   constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3055     //   functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3056     //   that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3057     //   the parentheses of the initializer.
3058     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
3059         (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
3060          S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
3061       ConstructorsOnly = true;
3062 
3063     S.RequireCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType, 0);
3064     // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
3065     // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
3066     // to try to recover.
3067     if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
3068       // We're not going to find any constructors.
3069     } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3070                  = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
3071 
3072       Expr **Args = &From;
3073       unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3074       bool ListInitializing = false;
3075       if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3076         // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work.
3077         OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3078             S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet, AllowExplicit);
3079         if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3080           return Result;
3081         // Never mind.
3082         CandidateSet.clear();
3083 
3084         // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3085         // arguments, not the entire list.
3086         Args = InitList->getInits();
3087         NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3088         ListInitializing = true;
3089       }
3090 
3091       DeclContext::lookup_result R = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
3092       for (DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con = R.begin(), ConEnd = R.end();
3093            Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
3094         NamedDecl *D = *Con;
3095         DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
3096 
3097         // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
3098         CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = nullptr;
3099         FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
3100           = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3101         if (ConstructorTmpl)
3102           Constructor
3103             = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
3104         else
3105           Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
3106 
3107         bool Usable = !Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3108         if (ListInitializing)
3109           Usable = Usable && (AllowExplicit || !Constructor->isExplicit());
3110         else
3111           Usable = Usable &&Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit);
3112         if (Usable) {
3113           bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3114           if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3115             SuppressUserConversions = false;
3116             if (NumArgs == 1) {
3117               // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3118               // suppress conversions.
3119               SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3120                                                 S.Context, Constructor, ToType);
3121             }
3122           }
3123           if (ConstructorTmpl)
3124             S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
3125                                            /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr,
3126                                            llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3127                                            CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3128           else
3129             // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3130             // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
3131             S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
3132                                    llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3133                                    CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
3134         }
3135       }
3136     }
3137   }
3138 
3139   // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
3140   if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3141   } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(), 0)) {
3142     // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
3143   } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
3144                                    = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3145     if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
3146          = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3147       // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
3148       const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3149       for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
3150         DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3151         NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
3152         CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3153         if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3154           D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3155 
3156         CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3157         FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
3158         if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3159           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3160         else
3161           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3162 
3163         if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
3164           if (ConvTemplate)
3165             S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
3166                                              ActingContext, From, ToType,
3167                                              CandidateSet,
3168                                              AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3169           else
3170             S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
3171                                      From, ToType, CandidateSet,
3172                                      AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3173         }
3174       }
3175     }
3176   }
3177 
3178   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3179 
3180   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3181   switch (auto Result = CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(),
3182                                                         Best, true)) {
3183   case OR_Success:
3184   case OR_Deleted:
3185     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3186     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3187           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3188       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3189       //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3190       //   constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3191       //   sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3192       //   the argument of the constructor.
3193       //
3194       QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
3195       if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3196         // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3197         User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3198       } else {
3199         if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3200           User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3201         else {
3202           User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3203           User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3204         }
3205       }
3206       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3207       User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3208       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3209       User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3210       User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3211       User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3212       return Result;
3213     }
3214     if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3215                  = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3216       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3217       //
3218       //   [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3219       //   conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3220       //   conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3221       //   implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3222       User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3223       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3224       User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
3225       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3226       User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3227 
3228       // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3229       //   The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3230       //   result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3231       //   for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3232       //   is an initialization, the special rules for
3233       //   initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3234       //   selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3235       //   user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3236       //   13.3.3.1).
3237       User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3238       return Result;
3239     }
3240     llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
3241 
3242   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3243     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3244 
3245   case OR_Ambiguous:
3246     return OR_Ambiguous;
3247   }
3248 
3249   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3250 }
3251 
3252 bool
3253 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
3254   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3255   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(),
3256                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
3257   OverloadingResult OvResult =
3258     IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
3259                             CandidateSet, false, false);
3260   if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
3261     Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3262         << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3263   else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()) {
3264     if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType,
3265                              diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete,
3266                              From->getType(), From->getSourceRange()))
3267       Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3268           << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType;
3269   } else
3270     return false;
3271   CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, From);
3272   return true;
3273 }
3274 
3275 /// \brief Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3276 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3277 /// is possible.
3278 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3279 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1,
3280                            FunctionDecl *Function2) {
3281   if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC1 || !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11)
3282     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3283 
3284   // Objective-C++:
3285   //   If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3286   //   a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3287   //   respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3288   //   because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3289   //   to keep code working.
3290   CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3291   if (!Conv1)
3292     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3293 
3294   CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3295   if (!Conv2)
3296     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3297 
3298   if (Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() && Conv2->getParent()->isLambda()) {
3299     bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3300     bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3301     if (Block1 != Block2)
3302       return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3303                     : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3304   }
3305 
3306   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3307 }
3308 
3309 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(
3310     const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
3311   return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) ||
3312          (ICS.isUserDefined() &&
3313           ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr);
3314 }
3315 
3316 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3317 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3318 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
3319 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3320 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3321                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3322                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
3323 {
3324   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3325   // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3326   //   -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3327   //      conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3328   //      an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3329   //   -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3330   //      conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3331   //      (13.3.3.1.3).
3332   //
3333   // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3334   //   For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3335   //   described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3336   //   treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3337   //   from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
3338 
3339   // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has
3340   // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at
3341   // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse
3342   // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the
3343   // standard. For example:
3344   //
3345   // int &f(...);    // #1
3346   // void f(char*);  // #2
3347   // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); }
3348   //
3349   // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function.
3350   // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis
3351   // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there
3352   // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't
3353   // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11.
3354   // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued
3355   // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11.
3356 
3357   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
3358       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) !=
3359       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2))
3360     return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1)
3361                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3362                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3363 
3364   if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3365     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3366   if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
3367     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3368 
3369   // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3370   // the same kind.
3371   if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3372     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3373 
3374   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3375       ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3376 
3377   // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3378   // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3379   // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3380 
3381   // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3382   // list-initialization sequence L2 if:
3383   // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or,
3384   //   if not that,
3385   // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T",
3386   //   and N1 is smaller than N2.,
3387   // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply.
3388   if (!ICS1.isBad()) {
3389     if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3390         !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3391       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3392     if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3393         ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3394       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3395   }
3396 
3397   if (ICS1.isStandard())
3398     // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than
3399     // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...]
3400     Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3401                                                 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
3402   else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
3403     // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3404     // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3405     // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3406     // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3407     // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3408     // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3409     if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
3410           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
3411       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
3412                                                   ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3413                                                   ICS2.UserDefined.After);
3414     else
3415       Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3416                                           ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3417                                           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
3418   }
3419 
3420   return Result;
3421 }
3422 
3423 static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
3424   while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3425     Qualifiers Quals;
3426     T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
3427     T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
3428   }
3429 
3430   return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
3431 }
3432 
3433 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3434 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3435 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3436 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3437                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3438                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3439   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3440     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3441 
3442   // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
3443   // any non-identity conversion sequence
3444   if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3445     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3446   else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3447     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3448 
3449   if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3450     if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3451       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3452     else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3453       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3454     else
3455       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3456   } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
3457     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3458 
3459   if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3460     return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3461                              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3462   }
3463 
3464   if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3465     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3466              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3467              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3468 
3469   if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3470     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3471              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3472              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3473 
3474   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3475 }
3476 
3477 /// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3478 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3479 static bool
3480 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3481                              const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3482   // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3483   //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3484   //      implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
3485   //      without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
3486   //      to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
3487   //      lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
3488   //      reference*.
3489   //
3490   // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3491   // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3492   // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3493   // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3494   // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
3495   if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3496       SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3497     return false;
3498 
3499   return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3500           SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3501          (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3502           !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue);
3503 }
3504 
3505 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3506 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3507 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3508 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3509 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
3510                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3511                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
3512 {
3513   // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3514   // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3515 
3516   //  -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3517   //     sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3518   //     excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3519   //     sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3520   //     non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
3521   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
3522         = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
3523     return CK;
3524 
3525   //  -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3526   //     defined below), or, if not that,
3527   ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3528   ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3529   if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3530     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3531   else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3532     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3533 
3534   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3535   // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3536   // applies:
3537 
3538   //   A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3539   //   pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3540   //   that is such a conversion.
3541   if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3542     return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3543              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3544              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3545 
3546   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3547   //
3548   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
3549   //   conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3550   //   void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
3551   //   of B* to void*.
3552   bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
3553     = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
3554   bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
3555     = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
3556   if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3557     // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
3558     // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
3559     return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3560                               : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3561   } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
3562     // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
3563     // their derived-to-base conversions.
3564     if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
3565           = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
3566       return DerivedCK;
3567   } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
3568              !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
3569     // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
3570     // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
3571     // inheritance relationship in their sources.
3572     QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3573     QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
3574 
3575     // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3576     // conversion, if we need to.
3577     if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
3578       FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
3579     if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
3580       FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
3581 
3582     QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3583     QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3584 
3585     if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
3586       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3587     else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
3588       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3589 
3590     // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
3591     // other, it is the better one.
3592     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
3593       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3594     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
3595       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3596     if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
3597       bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
3598                                                           FromObjCPtr2);
3599       bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
3600                                                            FromObjCPtr1);
3601       if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
3602         return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3603                          : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3604       }
3605     }
3606   }
3607 
3608   // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
3609   // bullet 3).
3610   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
3611         = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
3612     return QualCK;
3613 
3614   if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
3615     // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
3616     if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
3617       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3618     else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
3619       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3620 
3621     // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3622     //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
3623     //      which the references refer are the same type except for
3624     //      top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
3625     //      initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
3626     //      to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
3627     QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3628     QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
3629     T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3630     T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
3631     Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3632     QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3633     QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3634     if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3635       // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
3636       // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
3637       if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
3638                                           SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
3639         return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
3640                                            ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3641                                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3642       }
3643 
3644       // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
3645       // type for comparison.
3646       if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3647         T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3648       if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3649         T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3650       if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
3651         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3652       else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
3653         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3654     }
3655   }
3656 
3657   // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
3658   // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
3659   // is between types of the same size.
3660   // For example:
3661   // void f(float);
3662   // void f(int);
3663   // int main {
3664   //    long a;
3665   //    f(a);
3666   // }
3667   // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
3668   // as clang will do in standard mode.
3669   if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
3670       SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
3671       S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
3672           S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
3673     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3674 
3675   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3676 }
3677 
3678 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3679 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
3680 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
3681 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3682 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
3683                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3684                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3685   // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
3686   //  -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
3687   //     yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
3688   //     cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3689   //     the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3690   //     deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3691   if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3692       SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3693     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3694 
3695   // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3696   // conversion (!)
3697   QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3698   QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
3699   T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3700   T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
3701   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3702   QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3703   QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3704 
3705   // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3706   // them.
3707   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
3708     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3709 
3710   // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3711   // for comparison.
3712   if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3713     T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3714   if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3715     T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3716 
3717   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3718     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3719 
3720   // Objective-C++ ARC:
3721   //   Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3722   //   to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3723   if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3724                                       SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3725     Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3726                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3727                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3728   }
3729 
3730   while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3731     // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3732     // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3733     // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
3734     // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
3735     // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3736     // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3737     // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3738     // strict subset of qualifiers.
3739     if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3740       // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3741       // about how the sequences rank.
3742       ;
3743     else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3744       // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3745       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3746         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3747         // qualifiers.
3748         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3749 
3750       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3751     } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3752       // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3753       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3754         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3755         // qualifiers.
3756         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3757 
3758       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3759     } else {
3760       // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3761       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3762     }
3763 
3764     // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
3765     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
3766       break;
3767   }
3768 
3769   // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3770   // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3771   switch (Result) {
3772   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
3773     if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
3774       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3775     break;
3776 
3777   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3778     break;
3779 
3780   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
3781     if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
3782       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3783     break;
3784   }
3785 
3786   return Result;
3787 }
3788 
3789 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3790 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
3791 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3792 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3).  As part of these checks, we also look at
3793 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
3794 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3795 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3796                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3797                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3798   QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3799   QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
3800   QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
3801   QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
3802 
3803   // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3804   // conversion, if we need to.
3805   if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
3806     FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
3807   if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
3808     FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
3809 
3810   // Canonicalize all of the types.
3811   FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3812   ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3813   FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3814   ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
3815 
3816   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
3817   //
3818   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3819   //   class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
3820   //
3821   // Compare based on pointer conversions.
3822   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3823       SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3824       /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3825       FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3826       ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
3827     QualType FromPointee1
3828       = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3829     QualType ToPointee1
3830       = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3831     QualType FromPointee2
3832       = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3833     QualType ToPointee2
3834       = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3835 
3836     //   -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3837     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
3838       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
3839         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3840       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
3841         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3842     }
3843 
3844     //   -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3845     if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
3846       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
3847         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3848       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
3849         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3850     }
3851   } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3852              SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3853     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3854       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3855     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3856       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3857     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3858       = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3859     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3860       = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3861 
3862     if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3863       // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3864       // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3865       // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3866       // Objective-C pointer types.
3867       bool FromAssignLeft
3868         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3869       bool FromAssignRight
3870         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3871       bool ToAssignLeft
3872         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3873       bool ToAssignRight
3874         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3875 
3876       // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3877       // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3878       if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3879           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3880         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3881       if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3882           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3883         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3884 
3885       // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3886       // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3887       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3888         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3889       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3890         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3891 
3892       // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3893       // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3894       if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3895           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3896         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3897       if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3898           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3899         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3900 
3901       // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3902       // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3903       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3904         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3905       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3906         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3907 
3908       //   -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3909       if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3910           !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3911           (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3912         return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3913                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3914 
3915       //   -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3916       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3917           (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3918         return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3919         : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3920     }
3921   }
3922 
3923   // Ranking of member-pointer types.
3924   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3925       FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3926       ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
3927     const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
3928                                         FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3929     const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
3930                                           ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3931     const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
3932                                           FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3933     const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
3934                                           ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3935     const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3936     const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3937     const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3938     const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3939     QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3940     QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3941     QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3942     QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3943     // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
3944     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
3945       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
3946         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3947       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
3948         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3949     }
3950     // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3951     if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
3952       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
3953         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3954       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
3955         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3956     }
3957   }
3958 
3959   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
3960     //   -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
3961     //   -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3962     //      B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3963     //      reference of type A&,
3964     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3965         !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3966       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
3967         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3968       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
3969         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3970     }
3971 
3972     //   -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
3973     //   -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3974     //      A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3975     //      reference of type A&,
3976     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3977         S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3978       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
3979         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3980       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
3981         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3982     }
3983   }
3984 
3985   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3986 }
3987 
3988 /// \brief Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid
3989 /// C++ class.
3990 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) {
3991   if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
3992     return !Record->isInvalidDecl();
3993 
3994   return true;
3995 }
3996 
3997 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3998 /// determine whether they are reference-related,
3999 /// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
4000 /// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
4001 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
4002 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
4003 /// type being initialized.
4004 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
4005 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
4006                                    QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
4007                                    bool &DerivedToBase,
4008                                    bool &ObjCConversion,
4009                                    bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
4010   assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
4011     "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
4012   assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
4013 
4014   QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
4015   QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
4016   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4017   QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4018   QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4019 
4020   // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4021   //   Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
4022   //   reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
4023   //   T1 is a base class of T2.
4024   DerivedToBase = false;
4025   ObjCConversion = false;
4026   ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4027   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4028     // Nothing to do.
4029   } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, 0) &&
4030              isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) &&
4031              IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
4032     DerivedToBase = true;
4033   else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4034            UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4035            Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
4036     ObjCConversion = true;
4037   else
4038     return Ref_Incompatible;
4039 
4040   // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
4041   // least).
4042 
4043   // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
4044   // for comparison.
4045   if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
4046     T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
4047   if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
4048     T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
4049 
4050   // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4051   //   "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
4052   //   reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
4053   //   as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
4054   //   overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
4055   //   cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
4056   //   reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
4057   //
4058   // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
4059   // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
4060   // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
4061   // space 2.
4062   if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
4063       T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
4064     if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(T2Quals, T1Quals))
4065       ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
4066 
4067     T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4068     T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4069   }
4070 
4071   if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
4072     return Ref_Compatible;
4073   else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4074     return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
4075   else
4076     return Ref_Related;
4077 }
4078 
4079 /// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
4080 ///        with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4081 static bool
4082 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4083                          QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4084                          Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4085                          bool AllowExplicit) {
4086   assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4087   CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
4088     = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4089 
4090   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
4091   const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4092   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
4093     NamedDecl *D = *I;
4094     CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4095     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4096       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4097 
4098     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4099       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4100     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4101     if (ConvTemplate)
4102       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4103     else
4104       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4105 
4106     // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
4107     // explicit conversions, skip it.
4108     if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
4109       continue;
4110 
4111     if (AllowRvalues) {
4112       bool DerivedToBase = false;
4113       bool ObjCConversion = false;
4114       bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4115 
4116       // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4117       // functions that return lvalues.
4118       if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4119         const ReferenceType *RefType
4120           = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4121         if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4122           continue;
4123       }
4124 
4125       if (!ConvTemplate &&
4126           S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4127             DeclLoc,
4128             Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4129               .getUnqualifiedType(),
4130             DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
4131             DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
4132           Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
4133         continue;
4134     } else {
4135       // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4136       // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4137       // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4138 
4139       const ReferenceType *RefType =
4140         Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4141       if (!RefType ||
4142           (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4143            !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4144         continue;
4145     }
4146 
4147     if (ConvTemplate)
4148       S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
4149                                        Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4150                                        /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4151     else
4152       S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
4153                                DeclType, CandidateSet,
4154                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4155   }
4156 
4157   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4158 
4159   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
4160   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
4161   case OR_Success:
4162     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4163     //
4164     //   [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4165     //   applying a conversion function to the argument
4166     //   expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4167     //   user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4168     //   second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4169     //   conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4170     //   entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4171     //   type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4172     if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4173       return false;
4174 
4175     ICS.setUserDefined();
4176     ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4177     ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
4178     ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
4179     ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
4180     ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
4181     ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4182     assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4183            ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4184            "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4185     return true;
4186 
4187   case OR_Ambiguous:
4188     ICS.setAmbiguous();
4189     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4190          Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4191       if (Cand->Viable)
4192         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
4193     return true;
4194 
4195   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4196   case OR_Deleted:
4197     // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4198     // conversion; continue with other checks.
4199     return false;
4200   }
4201 
4202   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
4203 }
4204 
4205 /// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4206 /// initialization.
4207 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4208 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
4209                  SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4210                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
4211                  bool AllowExplicit) {
4212   assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4213 
4214   // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4215   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4216   ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4217 
4218   QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4219   QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4220 
4221   // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4222   // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4223   // type of the resulting function.
4224   if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4225     DeclAccessPair Found;
4226     if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4227                                                                 false, Found))
4228       T2 = Fn->getType();
4229   }
4230 
4231   // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4232   bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4233   bool DerivedToBase = false;
4234   bool ObjCConversion = false;
4235   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4236   Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
4237   Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4238     = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
4239                                      ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
4240 
4241 
4242   // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4243   //   A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4244   //   of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4245 
4246   //     -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
4247   if (!isRValRef) {
4248     //     -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4249     //        reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4250     //
4251     // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4252     if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
4253         RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
4254       // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4255       //   When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4256       //   to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4257       //   is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4258       //   has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4259       //   in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4260       //   derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4261       ICS.setStandard();
4262       ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
4263       ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4264                          : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4265                          : ICK_Identity;
4266       ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4267       ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4268       ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4269       ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4270       ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4271       ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4272       ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
4273       ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4274       ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4275       ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
4276       ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4277       ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
4278       ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
4279       ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
4280 
4281       // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4282       // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4283       // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4284       // [over.best.ics]p2).
4285       return ICS;
4286     }
4287 
4288     //       -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4289     //          not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4290     //          converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4291     //          is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4292     //          conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4293     //          conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4294     //          one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4295     if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
4296         !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
4297         RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
4298       if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4299                                    Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4300                                    AllowExplicit))
4301         return ICS;
4302     }
4303   }
4304 
4305   //     -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4306   //        non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
4307   //        shall be an rvalue reference.
4308   if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
4309     return ICS;
4310 
4311   //       -- If the initializer expression
4312   //
4313   //            -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
4314   //               lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
4315   if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
4316       (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4317       (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4318       (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4319     ICS.setStandard();
4320     ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
4321     ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4322                       : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4323                       : ICK_Identity;
4324     ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
4325     ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
4326     ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4327     ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4328     ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4329     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4330     // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4331     // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4332     // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4333     // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4334     // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
4335     ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
4336       S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
4337       !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType());
4338     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4339     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4340     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
4341     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4342     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
4343     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
4344     ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
4345     return ICS;
4346   }
4347 
4348   //            -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4349   //               reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
4350   //               an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4351   //               "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
4352   //               "cv3 T3",
4353   //
4354   //          then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
4355   //          expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
4356   //          in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
4357   //          class subobject).
4358   if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4359       T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
4360       FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4361                                Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4362                                AllowExplicit)) {
4363     // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4364     // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4365     // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4366     // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
4367     if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
4368         ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4369       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4370 
4371     return ICS;
4372   }
4373 
4374   // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try.
4375   if (T1->isFunctionType())
4376     return ICS;
4377 
4378   //       -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4379   //          initialized from the initializer expression using the
4380   //          rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4381   //          reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4382   //          reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4383   //          cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4384   //          cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4385   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4386     // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4387     // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4388     // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4389     // initialization fails.
4390     //
4391     // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4392     // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
4393     Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4394     Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4395     T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4396     T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4397     T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4398     T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4399     if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4400       return ICS;
4401   }
4402 
4403   // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4404   // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4405   // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4406   // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4407   // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4408   if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4409       (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4410     return ICS;
4411 
4412   // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4413   // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4414   if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4415       isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4416     return ICS;
4417 
4418   // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
4419   //   When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4420   //   an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4421   //   required to convert the argument expression to the
4422   //   underlying type of the reference according to
4423   //   13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4424   //   to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4425   //   the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4426   //   cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4427   //   and does not constitute a conversion.
4428   ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4429                               /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4430                               /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4431                               /*CStyle=*/false,
4432                               /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4433                               /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4434 
4435   // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4436   if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4437     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4438     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4439     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4440     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
4441     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4442     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4443   } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
4444     const ReferenceType *LValRefType =
4445         ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType()
4446             ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4447 
4448     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3:
4449     //   Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a
4450     //   standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...]
4451     //   binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function
4452     //   lvalue.
4453     // Note that the function case is not possible here.
4454     if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType() && LValRefType) {
4455       // FIXME: This is the wrong BadConversionSequence. The problem is binding
4456       // an rvalue reference to a (non-function) lvalue, not binding an lvalue
4457       // reference to an rvalue!
4458       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType);
4459       return ICS;
4460     }
4461 
4462     ICS.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4463     ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
4464     ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4465     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4466     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType;
4467     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4468     ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4469   }
4470 
4471   return ICS;
4472 }
4473 
4474 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4475 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4476                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
4477                       bool InOverloadResolution,
4478                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4479                       bool AllowExplicit = false);
4480 
4481 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4482 /// initializer list From.
4483 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4484 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4485                   bool SuppressUserConversions,
4486                   bool InOverloadResolution,
4487                   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4488   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
4489   //   When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
4490   //   special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
4491 
4492   ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
4493   Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
4494 
4495   // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
4496   // initialized from init lists.
4497   if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, 0))
4498     return Result;
4499 
4500   // Per DR1467:
4501   //   If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single
4502   //   element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the
4503   //   implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element
4504   //   to the parameter type.
4505   //
4506   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ]
4507   //   and the initializer list has a single element that is an
4508   //   appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the
4509   //   implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion.
4510   if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4511     if (ToType->isRecordType()) {
4512       QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType();
4513       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) ||
4514           S.IsDerivedFrom(InitType, ToType))
4515         return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4516                                      SuppressUserConversions,
4517                                      InOverloadResolution,
4518                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4519     }
4520     // FIXME: Check the other conditions here: array of character type,
4521     // initializer is a string literal.
4522     if (ToType->isArrayType()) {
4523       InitializedEntity Entity =
4524         InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4525                                                /*Consumed=*/false);
4526       if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) {
4527         Result.setStandard();
4528         Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4529         Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4530         Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4531         return Result;
4532       }
4533     }
4534   }
4535 
4536   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below).
4537   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
4538   //   If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
4539   //   all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
4540   //   conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
4541   //   element of the list to X.
4542   //
4543   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3:
4544   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer
4545   //   list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is
4546   //   default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list
4547   //   can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is
4548   //   the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X.
4549   //
4550   // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks.
4551   bool toStdInitializerList = false;
4552   QualType X;
4553   if (ToType->isArrayType())
4554     X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
4555   else
4556     toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
4557   if (!X.isNull()) {
4558     for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
4559       Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
4560       ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4561           TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
4562                                 InOverloadResolution,
4563                                 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4564       // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
4565       if (ICS.isBad()) {
4566         Result = ICS;
4567         break;
4568       }
4569       // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
4570       if (Result.isBad() ||
4571           CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, ICS, Result) ==
4572               ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4573         Result = ICS;
4574     }
4575 
4576     // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
4577     // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
4578     if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
4579       Result.setStandard();
4580       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4581       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4582       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4583     }
4584 
4585     Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
4586     return Result;
4587   }
4588 
4589   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4:
4590   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
4591   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
4592   //   resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
4593   //   conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
4594   //   constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
4595   //   implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
4596   if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4597     // This function can deal with initializer lists.
4598     return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4599                                     /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4600                                     InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
4601                                     AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4602                                     /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4603   }
4604 
4605   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5:
4606   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
4607   //   Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
4608   //   initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
4609   //   sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
4610   if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
4611     // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
4612     // down to checking whether the initialization works.
4613     // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
4614     InitializedEntity Entity =
4615         InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
4616                                                /*Consumed=*/false);
4617     if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) {
4618       Result.setUserDefined();
4619       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
4620       // Initializer lists don't have a type.
4621       Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
4622       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
4623 
4624       Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4625       Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
4626       Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4627       Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr;
4628     }
4629     return Result;
4630   }
4631 
4632   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6:
4633   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
4634   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
4635   if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
4636     // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
4637     // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
4638     // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
4639 
4640     QualType T1 = ToType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4641 
4642     // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
4643     // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
4644     if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
4645       Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
4646 
4647       QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4648 
4649       // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4650       // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4651       // type of the resulting function.
4652       if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4653         DeclAccessPair Found;
4654         if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
4655                                    Init, ToType, false, Found))
4656           T2 = Fn->getType();
4657       }
4658 
4659       // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4660       bool dummy1 = false;
4661       bool dummy2 = false;
4662       bool dummy3 = false;
4663       Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
4664         = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getLocStart(), T1, T2, dummy1,
4665                                          dummy2, dummy3);
4666 
4667       if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) {
4668         return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/From->getLocStart(),
4669                                 SuppressUserConversions,
4670                                 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
4671       }
4672     }
4673 
4674     // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
4675     // initializer list.
4676     Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4677                                InOverloadResolution,
4678                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4679     if (Result.isFailure())
4680       return Result;
4681     assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
4682            "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
4683 
4684     // Can we even bind to a temporary?
4685     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
4686         (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
4687       StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
4688                                             Result.UserDefined.After;
4689       SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
4690       SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
4691       SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
4692       SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4693       SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4694       SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4695     } else
4696       Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
4697                     From, ToType);
4698     return Result;
4699   }
4700 
4701   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7:
4702   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
4703   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
4704   if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
4705     //    - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an
4706     //      initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one
4707     //      required to convert the element to the parameter type.
4708     unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
4709     if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0)))
4710       Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
4711                                      SuppressUserConversions,
4712                                      InOverloadResolution,
4713                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4714     //    - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
4715     //      sequence is the identity conversion.
4716     else if (NumInits == 0) {
4717       Result.setStandard();
4718       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4719       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
4720       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4721     }
4722     return Result;
4723   }
4724 
4725   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8:
4726   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
4727   //   In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
4728   return Result;
4729 }
4730 
4731 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
4732 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
4733 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
4734 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
4735 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
4736 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
4737 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4738 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4739                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
4740                       bool InOverloadResolution,
4741                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4742                       bool AllowExplicit) {
4743   if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
4744     return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
4745                              InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
4746 
4747   if (ToType->isReferenceType())
4748     return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
4749                             /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
4750                             SuppressUserConversions,
4751                             AllowExplicit);
4752 
4753   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
4754                                SuppressUserConversions,
4755                                /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
4756                                InOverloadResolution,
4757                                /*CStyle=*/false,
4758                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4759                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4760 }
4761 
4762 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
4763                                   const CanQualType ToQTy,
4764                                   Sema &S,
4765                                   SourceLocation Loc,
4766                                   ExprValueKind FromVK) {
4767   OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
4768   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4769     TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
4770 
4771   return !ICS.isBad();
4772 }
4773 
4774 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
4775 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
4776 /// expression @p From.
4777 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4778 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
4779                                 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
4780                                 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
4781                                 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
4782   QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
4783   // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
4784   //                 const volatile object.
4785   unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
4786     Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
4787   QualType ImplicitParamType =  S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
4788 
4789   // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
4790   // to exit early.
4791   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4792 
4793   // We need to have an object of class type.
4794   if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
4795     FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
4796 
4797     // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
4798     // better have an lvalue.
4799     assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
4800   }
4801 
4802   assert(FromType->isRecordType());
4803 
4804   // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
4805   //   For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
4806   //   parameter is
4807   //
4808   //     - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
4809   //        ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
4810   //     - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
4811   //        ref-qualifier
4812   //
4813   // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
4814   // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
4815   //
4816   // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
4817   // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
4818   // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
4819   // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
4820   // non-constant references.
4821 
4822   // First check the qualifiers.
4823   QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
4824   if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
4825                                     != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
4826       !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
4827     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
4828                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
4829     return ICS;
4830   }
4831 
4832   // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
4833   // affects the conversion rank.
4834   QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
4835   ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
4836   if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
4837     SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
4838   } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
4839     SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
4840   else {
4841     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
4842                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
4843     return ICS;
4844   }
4845 
4846   // Check the ref-qualifier.
4847   switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
4848   case RQ_None:
4849     // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
4850     break;
4851 
4852   case RQ_LValue:
4853     if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
4854       // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
4855       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
4856                  ImplicitParamType);
4857       return ICS;
4858     }
4859     break;
4860 
4861   case RQ_RValue:
4862     if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
4863       // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
4864       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
4865                  ImplicitParamType);
4866       return ICS;
4867     }
4868     break;
4869   }
4870 
4871   // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
4872   ICS.setStandard();
4873   ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
4874   ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
4875   ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
4876   ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
4877   ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4878   ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
4879   ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
4880   ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4881   ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4882   ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4883     = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
4884   return ICS;
4885 }
4886 
4887 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4888 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4889 /// expression.
4890 ExprResult
4891 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
4892                                           NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
4893                                           NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
4894                                           CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
4895   QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
4896   QualType ImplicitParamRecordType  =
4897     Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4898 
4899   Expr::Classification FromClassification;
4900   if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
4901     FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4902     DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
4903     FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
4904   } else {
4905     FromRecordType = From->getType();
4906     DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
4907     FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
4908   }
4909 
4910   // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4911   // the actual argument initialization.
4912   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
4913       *this, From->getType(), FromClassification, Method, Method->getParent());
4914   if (ICS.isBad()) {
4915     if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4916       Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4917       Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4918       unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4919       if (CVR) {
4920         Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4921              diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4922           << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4923           << From->getSourceRange();
4924         Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4925           << Method->getDeclName();
4926         return ExprError();
4927       }
4928     }
4929 
4930     return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4931                 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
4932        << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
4933   }
4934 
4935   if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4936     ExprResult FromRes =
4937       PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4938     if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4939       return ExprError();
4940     From = FromRes.get();
4941   }
4942 
4943   if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
4944     From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
4945                              From->getValueKind()).get();
4946   return From;
4947 }
4948 
4949 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4950 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
4951 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4952 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
4953   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
4954                                /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4955                                /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
4956                                /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4957                                /*CStyle=*/false,
4958                                /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4959                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4960 }
4961 
4962 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4963 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
4964 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
4965   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
4966     return ExprError();
4967 
4968   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
4969   if (!ICS.isBad())
4970     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
4971 
4972   if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
4973     return Diag(From->getLocStart(),
4974                 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
4975                   << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
4976   return ExprError();
4977 }
4978 
4979 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
4980 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
4981 /// is acceptable.
4982 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
4983                                               StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4984   // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
4985   // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
4986   // conversions are fine.
4987   switch (SCS.Second) {
4988   case ICK_Identity:
4989   case ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment:
4990   case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
4991   case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere.
4992     return true;
4993 
4994   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
4995     // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
4996     // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral
4997     // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression.
4998     //
4999     // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks
5000     // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this
5001     // (non-conforming) extension.
5002     return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5003            SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
5004 
5005   case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
5006   case ICK_Pointer_Member:
5007     // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are
5008     // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t.
5009     return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType();
5010 
5011   case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
5012   case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
5013   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
5014   case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
5015   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
5016   case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
5017   case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
5018   case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
5019   case ICK_Vector_Splat:
5020   case ICK_Complex_Real:
5021   case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
5022   case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
5023   case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
5024   case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
5025   case ICK_C_Only_Conversion:
5026     return false;
5027 
5028   case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
5029   case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
5030   case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
5031     llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second");
5032 
5033   case ICK_Qualification:
5034     llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second");
5035 
5036   case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
5037     break;
5038   }
5039 
5040   llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
5041 }
5042 
5043 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
5044 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
5045 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
5046 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From,
5047                                                    QualType T, APValue &Value,
5048                                                    Sema::CCEKind CCE,
5049                                                    bool RequireInt) {
5050   assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 &&
5051          "converted constant expression outside C++11");
5052 
5053   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From))
5054     return ExprError();
5055 
5056   // C++1z [expr.const]p3:
5057   //  A converted constant expression of type T is an expression,
5058   //  implicitly converted to type T, where the converted
5059   //  expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion
5060   //  sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...].
5061   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5062     TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T,
5063                           /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5064                           /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5065                           /*AllowObjcWritebackConversion=*/false,
5066                           /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
5067   StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr;
5068   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5069   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5070     SCS = &ICS.Standard;
5071     break;
5072   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5073     // We are converting to a non-class type, so the Before sequence
5074     // must be trivial.
5075     SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
5076     break;
5077   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5078   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5079     if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
5080       return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5081                     diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
5082                 << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5083     return ExprError();
5084 
5085   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5086     llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
5087   }
5088 
5089   // Check that we would only use permitted conversions.
5090   if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) {
5091     return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5092                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
5093              << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5094   }
5095   // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly.
5096   if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) {
5097     return S.Diag(From->getLocStart(),
5098                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect)
5099              << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5100   }
5101 
5102   ExprResult Result =
5103       S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting);
5104   if (Result.isInvalid())
5105     return Result;
5106 
5107   // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
5108   APValue PreNarrowingValue;
5109   QualType PreNarrowingType;
5110   switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
5111                                 PreNarrowingType)) {
5112   case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
5113     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
5114     // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
5115   case NK_Not_Narrowing:
5116     break;
5117 
5118   case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
5119     S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5120       << CCE << /*Constant*/1
5121       << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
5122     break;
5123 
5124   case NK_Type_Narrowing:
5125     S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5126       << CCE << /*Constant*/0 << From->getType() << T;
5127     break;
5128   }
5129 
5130   // Check the expression is a constant expression.
5131   SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
5132   Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5133   Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5134 
5135   if ((T->isReferenceType()
5136            ? !Result.get()->EvaluateAsLValue(Eval, S.Context)
5137            : !Result.get()->EvaluateAsRValue(Eval, S.Context)) ||
5138       (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) {
5139     // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5140     // the AST.
5141     Result = ExprError();
5142   } else {
5143     Value = Eval.Val;
5144 
5145     if (Notes.empty()) {
5146       // It's a constant expression.
5147       return Result;
5148     }
5149   }
5150 
5151   // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5152   if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5153       Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr)
5154     S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5155   else {
5156     S.Diag(From->getLocStart(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
5157       << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5158     for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5159       S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5160   }
5161   return ExprError();
5162 }
5163 
5164 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
5165                                                   APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE) {
5166   return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false);
5167 }
5168 
5169 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
5170                                                   llvm::APSInt &Value,
5171                                                   CCEKind CCE) {
5172   assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
5173 
5174   APValue V;
5175   auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true);
5176   if (!R.isInvalid())
5177     Value = V.getInt();
5178   return R;
5179 }
5180 
5181 
5182 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5183 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them.  This may change
5184 /// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5185 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5186   if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5187     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5188     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5189     SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5190   }
5191 }
5192 
5193 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5194 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5195 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5196 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5197   // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5198   QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5199   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5200     = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5201                             // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5202                             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5203                             /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
5204                             /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5205                             /*CStyle=*/false,
5206                             /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5207                             /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true);
5208 
5209   // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5210   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5211   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5212   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5213   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5214     break;
5215 
5216   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5217     dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5218     break;
5219 
5220   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5221     dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5222     break;
5223   }
5224 
5225   return ICS;
5226 }
5227 
5228 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5229 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5230 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
5231   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5232     return ExprError();
5233 
5234   QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
5235   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5236     TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
5237   if (!ICS.isBad())
5238     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
5239   return ExprError();
5240 }
5241 
5242 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5243 /// type of a permitted flavor.
5244 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) {
5245   return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5246                                  : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
5247 }
5248 
5249 static ExprResult
5250 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5251                             Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5252                             QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) {
5253 
5254   if (Converter.Suppress)
5255     return ExprError();
5256 
5257   Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5258   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5259     CXXConversionDecl *Conv =
5260         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5261     QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5262     Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy);
5263   }
5264   return From;
5265 }
5266 
5267 static bool
5268 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5269                            Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5270                            QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5271                            UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) {
5272   if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) {
5273     DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5274     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5275         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5276 
5277     // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5278     // conversion; use it.
5279     QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5280     std::string TypeStr;
5281     ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy());
5282 
5283     Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5284         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
5285                                       "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5286         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
5287                SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()), ")");
5288     Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy);
5289 
5290     // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
5291     // explicit conversion function.
5292     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5293       return true;
5294 
5295     SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5296     ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5297                                                        HadMultipleCandidates);
5298     if (Result.isInvalid())
5299       return true;
5300     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5301     From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5302                                     CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5303                                     nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind());
5304   }
5305   return false;
5306 }
5307 
5308 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5309                              Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5310                              QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5311                              DeclAccessPair &Found) {
5312   CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5313       cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5314   SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5315 
5316   QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5317   if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) {
5318     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5319       return true;
5320 
5321     Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType)
5322         << From->getSourceRange();
5323   }
5324 
5325   ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5326                                                      HadMultipleCandidates);
5327   if (Result.isInvalid())
5328     return true;
5329   // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5330   From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5331                                   CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5332                                   nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind());
5333   return false;
5334 }
5335 
5336 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion(
5337     Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5338     Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5339   if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress)
5340     Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType())
5341         << From->getSourceRange();
5342 
5343   return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5344 }
5345 
5346 static void
5347 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5348                                   UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions,
5349                                   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5350   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5351     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I];
5352     NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
5353     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
5354     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5355       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5356 
5357     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
5358     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
5359     if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
5360       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5361     else
5362       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5363 
5364     if (ConvTemplate)
5365       SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
5366         ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet,
5367         /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5368     else
5369       SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From,
5370                                      ToType, CandidateSet,
5371                                      /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5372   }
5373 }
5374 
5375 /// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted
5376 /// by the given converter.
5377 ///
5378 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a
5379 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class
5380 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching
5381 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only
5382 /// one target type.
5383 ///
5384 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
5385 /// conversion.
5386 ///
5387 /// \param From The expression we're converting from.
5388 ///
5389 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process.
5390 ///
5391 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
5392 /// successful.
5393 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion(
5394     SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5395   // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
5396   if (From->isTypeDependent())
5397     return From;
5398 
5399   // Process placeholders immediately.
5400   if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
5401     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
5402     if (result.isInvalid())
5403       return result;
5404     From = result.get();
5405   }
5406 
5407   // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden.
5408   QualType T = From->getType();
5409   if (Converter.match(T))
5410     return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5411 
5412   // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
5413 
5414   // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class
5415   // type.
5416   const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
5417   if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
5418     if (!Converter.Suppress)
5419       Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5420     return From;
5421   }
5422 
5423   // We must have a complete class type.
5424   struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
5425     ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter;
5426     Expr *From;
5427 
5428     TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From)
5429         : TypeDiagnoser(Converter.Suppress), Converter(Converter), From(From) {}
5430 
5431     void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
5432       Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5433     }
5434   } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From);
5435 
5436   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
5437     return From;
5438 
5439   // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
5440   UnresolvedSet<4>
5441       ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y.
5442   UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
5443   const auto &Conversions =
5444       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
5445 
5446   bool HadMultipleCandidates =
5447       (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1);
5448 
5449   // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y:
5450   QualType ToType;
5451   bool HasUniqueTargetType = true;
5452 
5453   // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions.
5454   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
5455     NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
5456     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion;
5457     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
5458     if (ConvTemplate) {
5459       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14)
5460         Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5461       else
5462         continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?).
5463     } else
5464       Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5465 
5466     assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) &&
5467            "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially "
5468            "viable in C++1y");
5469 
5470     QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5471     if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) {
5472 
5473       if (Conversion->isExplicit()) {
5474         // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction?
5475         // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion()
5476         if (!ConvTemplate)
5477           ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5478       } else {
5479         if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
5480           if (ToType.isNull())
5481             ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType();
5482           else if (HasUniqueTargetType &&
5483                    (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType))
5484             HasUniqueTargetType = false;
5485         }
5486         ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
5487       }
5488     }
5489   }
5490 
5491   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
5492     // C++1y [conv]p6:
5493     // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context
5494     // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified
5495     // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly
5496     // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched
5497     // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to
5498     // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be
5499     // exactly one such T.
5500 
5501     // If no unique T is found:
5502     if (ToType.isNull()) {
5503       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5504                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
5505                                      ExplicitConversions))
5506         return ExprError();
5507       return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
5508     }
5509 
5510     // If more than one unique Ts are found:
5511     if (!HasUniqueTargetType)
5512       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5513                                          ViableConversions);
5514 
5515     // If one unique T is found:
5516     // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded
5517     // potentially viable conversions.
5518     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
5519     collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions,
5520                                       CandidateSet);
5521 
5522     // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set.
5523     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
5524     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) {
5525     case OR_Success: {
5526       // Apply this conversion.
5527       DeclAccessPair Found =
5528           DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
5529       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5530                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5531         return ExprError();
5532       break;
5533     }
5534     case OR_Ambiguous:
5535       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5536                                          ViableConversions);
5537     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
5538       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5539                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
5540                                      ExplicitConversions))
5541         return ExprError();
5542     // fall through 'OR_Deleted' case.
5543     case OR_Deleted:
5544       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5545       break;
5546     }
5547   } else {
5548     switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
5549     case 0: {
5550       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5551                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
5552                                      ExplicitConversions))
5553         return ExprError();
5554 
5555       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
5556       break;
5557     }
5558     case 1: {
5559       // Apply this conversion.
5560       DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
5561       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5562                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
5563         return ExprError();
5564       break;
5565     }
5566     default:
5567       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
5568                                          ViableConversions);
5569     }
5570   }
5571 
5572   return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
5573 }
5574 
5575 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is
5576 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose
5577 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine
5578 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning
5579 /// enumeration types.
5580 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context,
5581                                                    FunctionDecl *Fn,
5582                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
5583   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
5584   QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType();
5585 
5586   if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType()))
5587     return true;
5588 
5589   if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType()))
5590     return true;
5591 
5592   const FunctionProtoType *Proto = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
5593   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1)
5594     return false;
5595 
5596   if (T1->isEnumeralType()) {
5597     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType();
5598     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType))
5599       return true;
5600   }
5601 
5602   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2)
5603     return false;
5604 
5605   if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) {
5606     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType();
5607     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType))
5608       return true;
5609   }
5610 
5611   return false;
5612 }
5613 
5614 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
5615 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments.  If
5616 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
5617 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
5618 ///
5619 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
5620 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
5621 /// code completion.
5622 void
5623 Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
5624                            DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
5625                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5626                            OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
5627                            bool SuppressUserConversions,
5628                            bool PartialOverloading,
5629                            bool AllowExplicit) {
5630   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
5631     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
5632   assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
5633   assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
5634          "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
5635 
5636   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
5637     if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
5638       // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
5639       // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
5640       // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
5641       // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
5642       // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
5643       // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
5644       // is irrelevant.
5645       AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
5646                          QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
5647                          Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
5648                          PartialOverloading);
5649       return;
5650     }
5651     // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
5652     // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
5653   }
5654 
5655   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
5656     return;
5657 
5658   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5659   //   if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the
5660   //   lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to
5661   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there
5662   //   is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to
5663   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are
5664   //   candidate functions.
5665   if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
5666       !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args))
5667     return;
5668 
5669   // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402]
5670   //   A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by
5671   //   overload resolution.
5672   CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function);
5673   if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() &&
5674       Constructor->isMoveConstructor())
5675     return;
5676 
5677   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
5678   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
5679 
5680   // Add this candidate
5681   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
5682   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
5683   Candidate.Function = Function;
5684   Candidate.Viable = true;
5685   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5686   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
5687   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
5688 
5689   if (Constructor) {
5690     // C++ [class.copy]p3:
5691     //   A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
5692     //   of a class object to an object of its class type.
5693     QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
5694     if (Args.size() == 1 &&
5695         Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
5696         (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
5697          IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType))) {
5698       Candidate.Viable = false;
5699       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor;
5700       return;
5701     }
5702   }
5703 
5704   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
5705 
5706   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
5707   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
5708   // list (8.3.5).
5709   if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) &&
5710       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
5711     Candidate.Viable = false;
5712     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
5713     return;
5714   }
5715 
5716   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
5717   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
5718   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
5719   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
5720   // exactly m parameters.
5721   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
5722   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
5723     // Not enough arguments.
5724     Candidate.Viable = false;
5725     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
5726     return;
5727   }
5728 
5729   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
5730   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
5731     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
5732       // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this
5733       // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is
5734       // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of
5735       // the class.
5736       if (!Caller->isImplicit() && CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
5737         Candidate.Viable = false;
5738         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
5739         return;
5740       }
5741 
5742   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5743   // arguments.
5744   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
5745     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
5746       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5747       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5748       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5749       // parameter of F.
5750       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
5751       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
5752         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
5753                                 SuppressUserConversions,
5754                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5755                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5756                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
5757                                 AllowExplicit);
5758       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5759         Candidate.Viable = false;
5760         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
5761         return;
5762       }
5763     } else {
5764       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5765       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5766       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
5767       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
5768     }
5769   }
5770 
5771   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Function, Args)) {
5772     Candidate.Viable = false;
5773     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
5774     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
5775     return;
5776   }
5777 }
5778 
5779 ObjCMethodDecl *Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args,
5780                                        bool IsInstance) {
5781   SmallVector<ObjCMethodDecl*, 4> Methods;
5782   if (!CollectMultipleMethodsInGlobalPool(Sel, Methods, IsInstance))
5783     return nullptr;
5784 
5785   for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
5786     bool Match = true;
5787     ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b];
5788     unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs();
5789     // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due
5790     // to addition of c-style arguments in method.
5791     if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs)
5792       NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size();
5793     if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs)
5794       continue;
5795 
5796     for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) {
5797       // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument.
5798       if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
5799         Match = false;
5800         break;
5801       }
5802 
5803       ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i];
5804       Expr *argExpr = Args[i];
5805       assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression");
5806 
5807       // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's
5808       // a consumed argument.
5809       if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) &&
5810           !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())
5811         argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr);
5812 
5813       // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method.
5814       if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
5815         Match = false;
5816         break;
5817       }
5818 
5819       ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState
5820         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(),
5821                                 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false,
5822                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
5823                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5824                                 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
5825                                 /*AllowExplicit*/false);
5826         if (ConversionState.isBad()) {
5827           Match = false;
5828           break;
5829         }
5830     }
5831     // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods.
5832     if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) {
5833       for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) {
5834         if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
5835           Match = false;
5836           break;
5837         }
5838         ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
5839                                                           nullptr);
5840         if (Arg.isInvalid()) {
5841           Match = false;
5842           break;
5843         }
5844       }
5845     } else {
5846       // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods.
5847       if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs)
5848         Match = false;
5849       else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) {
5850         // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select
5851         // one with the most general result type of 'id'.
5852         for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
5853           QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType();
5854           if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType())
5855             return Methods[b];
5856         }
5857       }
5858     }
5859 
5860     if (Match)
5861       return Method;
5862   }
5863   return nullptr;
5864 }
5865 
5866 // specific_attr_iterator iterates over enable_if attributes in reverse, and
5867 // enable_if is order-sensitive. As a result, we need to reverse things
5868 // sometimes. Size of 4 elements is arbitrary.
5869 static SmallVector<EnableIfAttr *, 4>
5870 getOrderedEnableIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function) {
5871   SmallVector<EnableIfAttr *, 4> Result;
5872   if (!Function->hasAttrs())
5873     return Result;
5874 
5875   const auto &FuncAttrs = Function->getAttrs();
5876   for (Attr *Attr : FuncAttrs)
5877     if (auto *EnableIf = dyn_cast<EnableIfAttr>(Attr))
5878       Result.push_back(EnableIf);
5879 
5880   std::reverse(Result.begin(), Result.end());
5881   return Result;
5882 }
5883 
5884 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5885                                   bool MissingImplicitThis) {
5886   auto EnableIfAttrs = getOrderedEnableIfAttrs(Function);
5887   if (EnableIfAttrs.empty())
5888     return nullptr;
5889 
5890   SFINAETrap Trap(*this);
5891   SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs;
5892   bool InitializationFailed = false;
5893   bool ContainsValueDependentExpr = false;
5894 
5895   // Convert the arguments.
5896   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i) {
5897     if (i == 0 && !MissingImplicitThis && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Function) &&
5898         !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)->isStatic() &&
5899         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)) {
5900       CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function);
5901       ExprResult R =
5902         PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
5903                                             Method, Method);
5904       if (R.isInvalid()) {
5905         InitializationFailed = true;
5906         break;
5907       }
5908       ContainsValueDependentExpr |= R.get()->isValueDependent();
5909       ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
5910     } else {
5911       ExprResult R =
5912         PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
5913                                                 Context,
5914                                                 Function->getParamDecl(i)),
5915                                   SourceLocation(),
5916                                   Args[i]);
5917       if (R.isInvalid()) {
5918         InitializationFailed = true;
5919         break;
5920       }
5921       ContainsValueDependentExpr |= R.get()->isValueDependent();
5922       ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
5923     }
5924   }
5925 
5926   if (InitializationFailed || Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
5927     return EnableIfAttrs[0];
5928 
5929   // Push default arguments if needed.
5930   if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) {
5931     for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
5932       ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i);
5933       ExprResult R = PerformCopyInitialization(
5934           InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
5935                                                  Function->getParamDecl(i)),
5936           SourceLocation(),
5937           P->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg() ? P->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg()
5938                                            : P->getDefaultArg());
5939       if (R.isInvalid()) {
5940         InitializationFailed = true;
5941         break;
5942       }
5943       ContainsValueDependentExpr |= R.get()->isValueDependent();
5944       ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
5945     }
5946 
5947     if (InitializationFailed || Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
5948       return EnableIfAttrs[0];
5949   }
5950 
5951   for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) {
5952     APValue Result;
5953     if (EIA->getCond()->isValueDependent()) {
5954       // Don't even try now, we'll examine it after instantiation.
5955       continue;
5956     }
5957 
5958     if (!EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
5959             Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs))) {
5960       if (!ContainsValueDependentExpr)
5961         return EIA;
5962     } else if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue()) {
5963       return EIA;
5964     }
5965   }
5966   return nullptr;
5967 }
5968 
5969 /// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
5970 /// the overload candidate set.
5971 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
5972                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
5973                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5974                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
5975                                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
5976                                  bool PartialOverloading) {
5977   for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
5978     NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
5979     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
5980       if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
5981         AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
5982                            cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
5983                            Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
5984                            Args.slice(1), CandidateSet,
5985                            SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
5986       else
5987         AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, CandidateSet,
5988                              SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
5989     } else {
5990       FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
5991       if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
5992           !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
5993         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
5994                               cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
5995                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs,
5996                                    Args[0]->getType(),
5997                                    Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
5998                                    CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
5999                                    PartialOverloading);
6000       else
6001         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
6002                                      ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
6003                                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6004                                      PartialOverloading);
6005     }
6006   }
6007 }
6008 
6009 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
6010 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
6011 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6012                               QualType ObjectType,
6013                               Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6014                               ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6015                               OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6016                               bool SuppressUserConversions) {
6017   NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
6018   CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
6019 
6020   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
6021     Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
6022 
6023   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
6024     assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
6025            "Expected a member function template");
6026     AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
6027                                /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr,
6028                                ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6029                                Args, CandidateSet,
6030                                SuppressUserConversions);
6031   } else {
6032     AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
6033                        ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6034                        Args,
6035                        CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
6036   }
6037 }
6038 
6039 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
6040 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
6041 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
6042 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
6043 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
6044 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
6045 /// operators.
6046 void
6047 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6048                          CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
6049                          Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6050                          ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6051                          OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6052                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
6053                          bool PartialOverloading) {
6054   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
6055     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
6056   assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
6057   assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
6058          "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
6059 
6060   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
6061     return;
6062 
6063   // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402]
6064   //   A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is
6065   //   ignored by overload resolution.
6066   if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() &&
6067       Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
6068     return;
6069 
6070   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6071   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
6072 
6073   // Add this candidate
6074   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
6075   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6076   Candidate.Function = Method;
6077   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6078   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6079   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6080 
6081   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6082 
6083   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6084   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6085   // list (8.3.5).
6086   if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) &&
6087       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6088     Candidate.Viable = false;
6089     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6090     return;
6091   }
6092 
6093   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
6094   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
6095   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
6096   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
6097   // exactly m parameters.
6098   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
6099   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
6100     // Not enough arguments.
6101     Candidate.Viable = false;
6102     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6103     return;
6104   }
6105 
6106   Candidate.Viable = true;
6107 
6108   if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
6109     // The implicit object argument is ignored.
6110     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
6111   else {
6112     // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
6113     // parameter.
6114     Candidate.Conversions[0]
6115       = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6116                                         Method, ActingContext);
6117     if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
6118       Candidate.Viable = false;
6119       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6120       return;
6121     }
6122   }
6123 
6124   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
6125   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
6126     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
6127       if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Method)) {
6128         Candidate.Viable = false;
6129         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
6130         return;
6131       }
6132 
6133   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6134   // arguments.
6135   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
6136     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6137       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6138       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6139       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6140       // parameter of F.
6141       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6142       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
6143         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
6144                                 SuppressUserConversions,
6145                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6146                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6147                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
6148       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
6149         Candidate.Viable = false;
6150         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6151         return;
6152       }
6153     } else {
6154       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6155       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6156       // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6157       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
6158     }
6159   }
6160 
6161   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) {
6162     Candidate.Viable = false;
6163     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6164     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6165     return;
6166   }
6167 }
6168 
6169 /// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
6170 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
6171 /// function template specialization.
6172 void
6173 Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
6174                                  DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6175                                  CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
6176                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6177                                  QualType ObjectType,
6178                                  Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6179                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6180                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6181                                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
6182                                  bool PartialOverloading) {
6183   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
6184     return;
6185 
6186   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
6187   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
6188   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
6189   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
6190   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
6191   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
6192   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
6193   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
6194   //   functions.
6195   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
6196   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
6197   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
6198       = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
6199                                 Specialization, Info, PartialOverloading)) {
6200     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
6201     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6202     Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
6203     Candidate.Viable = false;
6204     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6205     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6206     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6207     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6208     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
6209                                                           Info);
6210     return;
6211   }
6212 
6213   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
6214   // deduction as a candidate.
6215   assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
6216   assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
6217          "Specialization is not a member function?");
6218   AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
6219                      ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
6220                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6221 }
6222 
6223 /// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
6224 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
6225 /// an appropriate function template specialization.
6226 void
6227 Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
6228                                    DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6229                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6230                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6231                                    OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6232                                    bool SuppressUserConversions,
6233                                    bool PartialOverloading) {
6234   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
6235     return;
6236 
6237   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
6238   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
6239   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
6240   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
6241   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
6242   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
6243   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
6244   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
6245   //   functions.
6246   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
6247   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
6248   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
6249         = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
6250                                   Specialization, Info, PartialOverloading)) {
6251     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
6252     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6253     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
6254     Candidate.Viable = false;
6255     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6256     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6257     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6258     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6259     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
6260                                                           Info);
6261     return;
6262   }
6263 
6264   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
6265   // deduction as a candidate.
6266   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
6267   AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
6268                        SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6269 }
6270 
6271 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result
6272 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++
6273 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1.
6274 ///
6275 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function.
6276 ///
6277 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to.
6278 ///
6279 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one
6280 /// Objective-C pointer to another.
6281 ///
6282 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise.
6283 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S,
6284                                           QualType ConvType, QualType ToType,
6285                                           bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) {
6286   QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
6287 
6288   // Easy case: the types are the same.
6289   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType))
6290     return true;
6291 
6292   // Allow qualification conversions.
6293   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
6294   if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false,
6295                                   ObjCLifetimeConversion))
6296     return true;
6297 
6298   // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions,
6299   // we're done.
6300   if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion)
6301     return false;
6302 
6303   // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion?
6304   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
6305   QualType ConvertedType;
6306   return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType,
6307                                    IncompatibleObjC);
6308 }
6309 
6310 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
6311 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
6312 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
6313 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
6314 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
6315 /// conversion function produces).
6316 void
6317 Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
6318                              DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6319                              CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
6320                              Expr *From, QualType ToType,
6321                              OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6322                              bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
6323   assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
6324          "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
6325   QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6326   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
6327     return;
6328 
6329   // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its
6330   // deduction now.
6331   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) {
6332     if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc()))
6333       return;
6334     ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6335   }
6336 
6337   // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion
6338   // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or
6339   // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion.
6340   if (Conversion->isExplicit() &&
6341       !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType,
6342                                      AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit))
6343     return;
6344 
6345   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6346   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
6347 
6348   // Add this candidate
6349   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
6350   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6351   Candidate.Function = Conversion;
6352   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6353   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6354   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
6355   Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
6356   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
6357   Candidate.Viable = true;
6358   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
6359 
6360   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
6361   //   For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
6362   //   the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
6363   //   defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
6364   //
6365   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
6366   // object parameter.
6367   QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
6368   if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
6369     ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
6370   CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
6371     = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
6372 
6373   Candidate.Conversions[0]
6374     = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
6375                                       From->Classify(Context),
6376                                       Conversion, ConversionContext);
6377 
6378   if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
6379     Candidate.Viable = false;
6380     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6381     return;
6382   }
6383 
6384   // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a
6385   // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
6386   // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
6387   QualType FromCanon
6388     = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
6389   QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
6390   if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
6391     Candidate.Viable = false;
6392     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
6393     return;
6394   }
6395 
6396   // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
6397   // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
6398   // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
6399   // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
6400   // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
6401   // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
6402   // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
6403   // well-formed.
6404   DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
6405                             VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
6406   ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
6407                                 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
6408                                 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
6409                                 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
6410 
6411   QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
6412   if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
6413     Candidate.Viable = false;
6414     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
6415     return;
6416   }
6417 
6418   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
6419 
6420   // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
6421   // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
6422   // allocator).
6423   QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
6424   CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, None, CallResultType, VK,
6425                 From->getLocStart());
6426   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
6427     TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
6428                           /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
6429                           /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6430                           /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
6431 
6432   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
6433   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
6434     Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
6435 
6436     // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
6437     //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
6438     //   conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
6439     //   shall have exact match rank.
6440     if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
6441         GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
6442       Candidate.Viable = false;
6443       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
6444       return;
6445     }
6446 
6447     // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
6448     //    In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
6449     //    the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
6450     //    conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
6451     //    program is ill-formed.
6452     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
6453         ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
6454       Candidate.Viable = false;
6455       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
6456       return;
6457     }
6458     break;
6459 
6460   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
6461     Candidate.Viable = false;
6462     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
6463     return;
6464 
6465   default:
6466     llvm_unreachable(
6467            "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
6468   }
6469 
6470   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) {
6471     Candidate.Viable = false;
6472     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6473     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6474     return;
6475   }
6476 }
6477 
6478 /// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
6479 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
6480 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
6481 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
6482 /// [temp.deduct.conv]).
6483 void
6484 Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
6485                                      DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6486                                      CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
6487                                      Expr *From, QualType ToType,
6488                                      OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6489                                      bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
6490   assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
6491          "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
6492 
6493   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
6494     return;
6495 
6496   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
6497   CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
6498   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
6499         = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
6500                                   Specialization, Info)) {
6501     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
6502     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6503     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
6504     Candidate.Viable = false;
6505     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
6506     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6507     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6508     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
6509     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
6510                                                           Info);
6511     return;
6512   }
6513 
6514   // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
6515   // template argument deduction as a candidate.
6516   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
6517   AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
6518                          CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
6519 }
6520 
6521 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
6522 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
6523 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
6524 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
6525 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
6526 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
6527                                  DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6528                                  CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
6529                                  const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
6530                                  Expr *Object,
6531                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6532                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
6533   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
6534     return;
6535 
6536   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6537   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
6538 
6539   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
6540   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6541   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
6542   Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
6543   Candidate.Viable = true;
6544   Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
6545   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6546   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6547 
6548   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
6549   // object parameter.
6550   ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
6551     = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
6552                                       Object->Classify(Context),
6553                                       Conversion, ActingContext);
6554   if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
6555     Candidate.Viable = false;
6556     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6557     Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
6558     return;
6559   }
6560 
6561   // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
6562   // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
6563   // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
6564   Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
6565   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
6566   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
6567   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
6568   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
6569   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
6570   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
6571     = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
6572   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
6573 
6574   // Find the
6575   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6576 
6577   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6578   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6579   // list (8.3.5).
6580   if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6581     Candidate.Viable = false;
6582     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6583     return;
6584   }
6585 
6586   // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
6587   // we have enough arguments.
6588   if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
6589     // Not enough arguments.
6590     Candidate.Viable = false;
6591     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6592     return;
6593   }
6594 
6595   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6596   // arguments.
6597   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
6598     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6599       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6600       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6601       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6602       // parameter of F.
6603       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6604       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
6605         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
6606                                 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
6607                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6608                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6609                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
6610       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
6611         Candidate.Viable = false;
6612         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6613         return;
6614       }
6615     } else {
6616       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6617       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6618       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6619       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
6620     }
6621   }
6622 
6623   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr = CheckEnableIf(Conversion, None)) {
6624     Candidate.Viable = false;
6625     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6626     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6627     return;
6628   }
6629 }
6630 
6631 /// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
6632 /// member functions.
6633 ///
6634 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
6635 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
6636 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
6637 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
6638 /// [over.match.oper]).
6639 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
6640                                        SourceLocation OpLoc,
6641                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6642                                        OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6643                                        SourceRange OpRange) {
6644   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
6645 
6646   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6647   //   For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
6648   //   cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
6649   //   a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
6650   //   a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
6651   //   three sets of candidate functions, designated member
6652   //   candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
6653   //   constructed as follows:
6654   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
6655 
6656   //     -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being
6657   //        defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the
6658   //        qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise,
6659   //        the set of member candidates is empty.
6660   if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
6661     // Complete the type if it can be completed.
6662     RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, 0);
6663     // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now.
6664     if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition())
6665       return;
6666 
6667     LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
6668     LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
6669     Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
6670 
6671     for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
6672                              OperEnd = Operators.end();
6673          Oper != OperEnd;
6674          ++Oper)
6675       AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
6676                          Args[0]->Classify(Context),
6677                          Args.slice(1),
6678                          CandidateSet,
6679                          /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
6680   }
6681 }
6682 
6683 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
6684 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
6685 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
6686 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
6687 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
6688 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
6689 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
6690 /// converted to bool.
6691 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
6692                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6693                                OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6694                                bool IsAssignmentOperator,
6695                                unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
6696   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6697   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
6698 
6699   // Add this candidate
6700   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
6701   Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none);
6702   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
6703   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6704   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6705   Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
6706   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
6707     Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
6708 
6709   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6710   // arguments.
6711   Candidate.Viable = true;
6712   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6713   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
6714     // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
6715     //   For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
6716     //   left operand are restricted as follows:
6717     //     -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
6718     //     -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
6719     //        operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
6720     //        parameter of a built-in candidate.
6721     //
6722     // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
6723     // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
6724     // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
6725     // is not of the same type.
6726     if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
6727       assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
6728              "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
6729       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6730         = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
6731     } else {
6732       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
6733         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
6734                                 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
6735                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
6736                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6737                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
6738     }
6739     if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
6740       Candidate.Viable = false;
6741       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6742       break;
6743     }
6744   }
6745 }
6746 
6747 namespace {
6748 
6749 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
6750 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
6751 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
6752 /// enumeration types.
6753 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet  {
6754   /// TypeSet - A set of types.
6755   typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
6756 
6757   /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
6758   /// built-in candidates.
6759   TypeSet PointerTypes;
6760 
6761   /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
6762   /// used in the built-in candidates.
6763   TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
6764 
6765   /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
6766   /// used in the built-in candidates.
6767   TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
6768 
6769   /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
6770   /// candidates.
6771   TypeSet VectorTypes;
6772 
6773   /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
6774   bool HasNonRecordTypes;
6775 
6776   /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
6777   /// were present in the candidate set.
6778   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
6779 
6780   /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
6781   /// candidate set.
6782   bool HasNullPtrType;
6783 
6784   /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
6785   /// candidate type set.
6786   Sema &SemaRef;
6787 
6788   /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
6789   ASTContext &Context;
6790 
6791   bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6792                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
6793   bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
6794 
6795 public:
6796   /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
6797   typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
6798 
6799   BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
6800     : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
6801       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
6802       HasNullPtrType(false),
6803       SemaRef(SemaRef),
6804       Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
6805 
6806   void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
6807                              SourceLocation Loc,
6808                              bool AllowUserConversions,
6809                              bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6810                              const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
6811 
6812   /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
6813   iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
6814 
6815   /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
6816   iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
6817 
6818   /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
6819   iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
6820 
6821   /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
6822   iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
6823 
6824   /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
6825   iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
6826 
6827   /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
6828   iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
6829 
6830   iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
6831   iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
6832 
6833   bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
6834   bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
6835   bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
6836 };
6837 
6838 } // end anonymous namespace
6839 
6840 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
6841 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6842 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6843 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6844 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6845 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6846 /// false otherwise.
6847 ///
6848 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
6849 bool
6850 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
6851                                              const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
6852 
6853   // Insert this type.
6854   if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty).second)
6855     return false;
6856 
6857   QualType PointeeTy;
6858   const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
6859   bool buildObjCPtr = false;
6860   if (!PointerTy) {
6861     const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
6862     PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
6863     buildObjCPtr = true;
6864   } else {
6865     PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
6866   }
6867 
6868   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6869   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6870   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6871   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6872   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6873     return true;
6874 
6875   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6876   bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
6877   bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
6878 
6879   // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
6880   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6881     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
6882     // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
6883     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
6884 
6885     // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
6886     // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
6887     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
6888         (!hasRestrict ||
6889          (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
6890       continue;
6891 
6892     // Build qualified pointee type.
6893     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
6894 
6895     // Build qualified pointer type.
6896     QualType QPointerTy;
6897     if (!buildObjCPtr)
6898       QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6899     else
6900       QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
6901 
6902     // Insert qualified pointer type.
6903     PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
6904   }
6905 
6906   return true;
6907 }
6908 
6909 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
6910 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
6911 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
6912 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
6913 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
6914 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
6915 /// false otherwise.
6916 ///
6917 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
6918 bool
6919 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
6920     QualType Ty) {
6921   // Insert this type.
6922   if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty).second)
6923     return false;
6924 
6925   const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
6926   assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
6927 
6928   QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
6929   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
6930   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
6931   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
6932   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
6933   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
6934     return true;
6935   const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
6936 
6937   // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
6938   // qualifiers.
6939   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
6940   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
6941     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
6942 
6943     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
6944     MemberPointerTypes.insert(
6945       Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
6946   }
6947 
6948   return true;
6949 }
6950 
6951 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
6952 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
6953 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
6954 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
6955 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
6956 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
6957 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
6958 /// type.
6959 void
6960 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
6961                                                SourceLocation Loc,
6962                                                bool AllowUserConversions,
6963                                                bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6964                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
6965   // Only deal with canonical types.
6966   Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
6967 
6968   // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
6969   // expression for the purposes of conversions.
6970   if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
6971     Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
6972 
6973   // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
6974   if (Ty->isArrayType())
6975     Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
6976 
6977   // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
6978   Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
6979 
6980   // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
6981   const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
6982   HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
6983 
6984   // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
6985   HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
6986     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
6987 
6988   if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
6989     PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
6990   else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
6991     // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
6992     // of types.
6993     if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
6994       return;
6995   } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
6996     // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
6997     if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
6998       return;
6999   } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
7000     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
7001     EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
7002   } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
7003     // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
7004     // extension.
7005     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
7006     VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
7007   } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
7008     HasNullPtrType = true;
7009   } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
7010     // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
7011     if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
7012       return;
7013 
7014     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
7015     for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) {
7016       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
7017         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
7018 
7019       // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
7020       // about which builtin types we can convert to.
7021       if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
7022         continue;
7023 
7024       CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
7025       if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
7026         AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
7027                               VisibleQuals);
7028       }
7029     }
7030   }
7031 }
7032 
7033 /// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
7034 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
7035 /// given type to the candidate set.
7036 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
7037                                                    QualType T,
7038                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7039                                     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
7040   QualType ParamTypes[2];
7041 
7042   // T& operator=(T&, T)
7043   ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
7044   ParamTypes[1] = T;
7045   S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7046                         /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
7047 
7048   if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
7049     // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
7050     ParamTypes[0]
7051       = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
7052     ParamTypes[1] = T;
7053     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7054                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
7055   }
7056 }
7057 
7058 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
7059 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
7060 static  Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
7061     Qualifiers VRQuals;
7062     const RecordType *TyRec;
7063     if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
7064         ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
7065       TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
7066     else
7067       TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
7068     if (!TyRec) {
7069       // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
7070       VRQuals.addVolatile();
7071       VRQuals.addRestrict();
7072       return VRQuals;
7073     }
7074 
7075     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
7076     if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
7077       return VRQuals;
7078 
7079     for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) {
7080       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
7081         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
7082       if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
7083         QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
7084         if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7085           CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
7086         // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
7087         // as see them.
7088         bool done = false;
7089         while (!done) {
7090           if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
7091             VRQuals.addRestrict();
7092           if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7093             CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7094           else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
7095                 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
7096             CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
7097           else
7098             done = true;
7099           if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
7100             VRQuals.addVolatile();
7101           if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
7102             return VRQuals;
7103         }
7104       }
7105     }
7106     return VRQuals;
7107 }
7108 
7109 namespace {
7110 
7111 /// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
7112 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
7113 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
7114 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
7115 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
7116   // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
7117   Sema &S;
7118   ArrayRef<Expr *> Args;
7119   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
7120   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
7121   SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
7122   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
7123 
7124   // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
7125   // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
7126   // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
7127   // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
7128   static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
7129   static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 20;
7130   static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
7131                         LastPromotedIntegralType = 11;
7132   static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
7133                         LastPromotedArithmeticType = 11;
7134   static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 20;
7135 
7136   /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
7137   CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
7138     assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
7139     static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
7140       ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
7141       // Start of promoted types.
7142       &ASTContext::FloatTy,
7143       &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
7144       &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
7145 
7146       // Start of integral types.
7147       &ASTContext::IntTy,
7148       &ASTContext::LongTy,
7149       &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
7150       &ASTContext::Int128Ty,
7151       &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
7152       &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
7153       &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
7154       &ASTContext::UnsignedInt128Ty,
7155       // End of promoted types.
7156 
7157       &ASTContext::BoolTy,
7158       &ASTContext::CharTy,
7159       &ASTContext::WCharTy,
7160       &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
7161       &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
7162       &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
7163       &ASTContext::ShortTy,
7164       &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
7165       &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
7166       // End of integral types.
7167       // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
7168     };
7169     return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
7170   }
7171 
7172   /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
7173   /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
7174   CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
7175     // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
7176     // The rules are basically:
7177     //   - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
7178     //   - if same signedness, use the higher rank
7179     //   - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
7180     //   - use the larger type
7181     // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
7182     // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
7183     // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
7184     // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
7185     // better not to make any assumptions).
7186     // We assume that int128 has a higher rank than long long on all platforms.
7187     enum PromotedType {
7188             Dep=-1,
7189             Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   SI,   SL,  SLL, S128,   UI,   UL,  ULL, U128
7190     };
7191     static const PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
7192                                         [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
7193 /* Flt*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt },
7194 /* Dbl*/ {  Dbl,  Dbl, LDbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl },
7195 /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
7196 /*  SI*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   SI,   SL,  SLL, S128,   UI,   UL,  ULL, U128 },
7197 /*  SL*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   SL,   SL,  SLL, S128,  Dep,   UL,  ULL, U128 },
7198 /* SLL*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,  SLL,  SLL,  SLL, S128,  Dep,  Dep,  ULL, U128 },
7199 /*S128*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, S128, U128 },
7200 /*  UI*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   UI,  Dep,  Dep, S128,   UI,   UL,  ULL, U128 },
7201 /*  UL*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   UL,   UL,  Dep, S128,   UL,   UL,  ULL, U128 },
7202 /* ULL*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,  ULL,  ULL,  ULL, S128,  ULL,  ULL,  ULL, U128 },
7203 /*U128*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128, U128 },
7204     };
7205 
7206     assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
7207     assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
7208     int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
7209 
7210     // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
7211     if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
7212 
7213     // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
7214     // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
7215     CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
7216                 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
7217     unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
7218              RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
7219 
7220     // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
7221     if (LW > RW) return LT;
7222     else if (LW < RW) return RT;
7223 
7224     // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
7225     if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
7226     assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
7227     return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
7228   }
7229 
7230   /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
7231   /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
7232   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
7233                                            bool HasVolatile,
7234                                            bool HasRestrict) {
7235     QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7236       S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
7237       S.Context.IntTy
7238     };
7239 
7240     // Non-volatile version.
7241     if (Args.size() == 1)
7242       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7243     else
7244       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7245 
7246     // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
7247     // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
7248     if (HasVolatile) {
7249       ParamTypes[0] =
7250         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7251           S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
7252       if (Args.size() == 1)
7253         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7254       else
7255         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7256     }
7257 
7258     // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
7259     // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
7260     if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
7261         !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
7262       ParamTypes[0]
7263         = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7264             S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
7265       if (Args.size() == 1)
7266         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7267       else
7268         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7269 
7270       if (HasVolatile) {
7271         ParamTypes[0]
7272           = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7273               S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
7274                                             (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7275                                              Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7276         if (Args.size() == 1)
7277           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7278         else
7279           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7280       }
7281     }
7282 
7283   }
7284 
7285 public:
7286   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
7287     Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7288     Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
7289     bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
7290     SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
7291     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
7292     : S(S), Args(Args),
7293       VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
7294       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
7295         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
7296       CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
7297       CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
7298     // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
7299     assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
7300            "Invalid first promoted integral type");
7301     assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
7302              == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
7303            "Invalid last promoted integral type");
7304     assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
7305              == S.Context.FloatTy &&
7306            "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
7307     assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
7308              == S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty &&
7309            "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
7310   }
7311 
7312   // C++ [over.built]p3:
7313   //
7314   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
7315   //   is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
7316   //   functions of the form
7317   //
7318   //       VQ T&      operator++(VQ T&);
7319   //       T          operator++(VQ T&, int);
7320   //
7321   // C++ [over.built]p4:
7322   //
7323   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
7324   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
7325   //   candidate operator functions of the form
7326   //
7327   //       VQ T&      operator--(VQ T&);
7328   //       T          operator--(VQ T&, int);
7329   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
7330     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7331       return;
7332 
7333     for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
7334          Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
7335       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
7336         getArithmeticType(Arith),
7337         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
7338         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
7339     }
7340   }
7341 
7342   // C++ [over.built]p5:
7343   //
7344   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7345   //   cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
7346   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7347   //
7348   //       T*VQ&      operator++(T*VQ&);
7349   //       T*VQ&      operator--(T*VQ&);
7350   //       T*         operator++(T*VQ&, int);
7351   //       T*         operator--(T*VQ&, int);
7352   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
7353     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7354               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7355            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7356          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7357       // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
7358       if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7359         continue;
7360 
7361       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
7362         (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7363          VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
7364         (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7365          VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
7366     }
7367   }
7368 
7369   // C++ [over.built]p6:
7370   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
7371   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
7372   //
7373   //       T&         operator*(T*);
7374   //
7375   // C++ [over.built]p7:
7376   //   For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
7377   //   ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7378   //       T&         operator*(T*);
7379   void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
7380     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7381               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7382            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7383          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7384       QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
7385       QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
7386       if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
7387         continue;
7388 
7389       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
7390         if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
7391           continue;
7392 
7393       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
7394                             &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7395     }
7396   }
7397 
7398   // C++ [over.built]p9:
7399   //  For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
7400   //  operator functions of the form
7401   //
7402   //       T         operator+(T);
7403   //       T         operator-(T);
7404   void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
7405     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7406       return;
7407 
7408     for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7409          Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
7410       QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
7411       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7412     }
7413 
7414     // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
7415     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7416               Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7417            VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7418          Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
7419       QualType VecTy = *Vec;
7420       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7421     }
7422   }
7423 
7424   // C++ [over.built]p8:
7425   //   For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
7426   //   the form
7427   //
7428   //       T*         operator+(T*);
7429   void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
7430     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7431               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7432            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7433          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7434       QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
7435       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7436     }
7437   }
7438 
7439   // C++ [over.built]p10:
7440   //   For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
7441   //   operator functions of the form
7442   //
7443   //        T         operator~(T);
7444   void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
7445     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7446       return;
7447 
7448     for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7449          Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
7450       QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
7451       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7452     }
7453 
7454     // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
7455     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7456               Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7457            VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7458          Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
7459       QualType VecTy = *Vec;
7460       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
7461     }
7462   }
7463 
7464   // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
7465   //   For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
7466   //   functions of the form
7467   //
7468   //        bool operator==(T,T);
7469   //        bool operator!=(T,T);
7470   void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
7471     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7472     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7473 
7474     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7475       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7476                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7477              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7478            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
7479            ++MemPtr) {
7480         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
7481         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second)
7482           continue;
7483 
7484         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
7485         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7486       }
7487     }
7488   }
7489 
7490   // C++ [over.built]p15:
7491   //
7492   //   For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
7493   //   std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7494   //
7495   //        bool       operator<(T, T);
7496   //        bool       operator>(T, T);
7497   //        bool       operator<=(T, T);
7498   //        bool       operator>=(T, T);
7499   //        bool       operator==(T, T);
7500   //        bool       operator!=(T, T);
7501   void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7502     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7503     //   [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
7504     //   functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
7505     //   do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
7506     //   candidate.
7507     //
7508     // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
7509     // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
7510     // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
7511     // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
7512     // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
7513     // where we must suppress candidates like this.
7514     llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
7515       UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
7516 
7517     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7518       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
7519           CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
7520         for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
7521                                          CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
7522              C != CEnd; ++C) {
7523           if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
7524             continue;
7525 
7526           if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
7527             continue;
7528 
7529           QualType FirstParamType =
7530             C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7531           QualType SecondParamType =
7532             C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
7533 
7534           // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
7535           if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
7536               !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
7537             continue;
7538 
7539           // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
7540           UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
7541             std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
7542                            S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
7543         }
7544       }
7545     }
7546 
7547     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7548     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7549 
7550     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7551       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7552                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
7553              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
7554            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7555         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
7556         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second)
7557           continue;
7558 
7559         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7560         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7561       }
7562       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7563                 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7564              EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7565            Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7566         CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
7567 
7568         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
7569         // candidate exists.
7570         if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second ||
7571             UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
7572                                                             CanonType)))
7573           continue;
7574 
7575         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
7576         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7577       }
7578 
7579       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
7580         CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
7581         if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second &&
7582             !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
7583                                                              NullPtrTy))) {
7584           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
7585           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args,
7586                                 CandidateSet);
7587         }
7588       }
7589     }
7590   }
7591 
7592   // C++ [over.built]p13:
7593   //
7594   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
7595   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7596   //
7597   //      T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
7598   //      T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);    [BELOW]
7599   //      T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
7600   //      T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
7601   //      T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);    [BELOW]
7602   //
7603   // C++ [over.built]p14:
7604   //
7605   //   For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
7606   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
7607   //
7608   //      ptrdiff_t  operator-(T, T);
7609   void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
7610     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7611     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7612 
7613     for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
7614       QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = {
7615         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7616         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7617       };
7618       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7619                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
7620              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
7621            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7622         QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
7623         if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
7624           continue;
7625 
7626         AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
7627         if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
7628           // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
7629           // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
7630           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7631         }
7632         if (Op == OO_Minus) {
7633           // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
7634           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second)
7635             continue;
7636 
7637           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
7638           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
7639                                 Args, CandidateSet);
7640         }
7641       }
7642     }
7643   }
7644 
7645   // C++ [over.built]p12:
7646   //
7647   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
7648   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
7649   //
7650   //        LR         operator*(L, R);
7651   //        LR         operator/(L, R);
7652   //        LR         operator+(L, R);
7653   //        LR         operator-(L, R);
7654   //        bool       operator<(L, R);
7655   //        bool       operator>(L, R);
7656   //        bool       operator<=(L, R);
7657   //        bool       operator>=(L, R);
7658   //        bool       operator==(L, R);
7659   //        bool       operator!=(L, R);
7660   //
7661   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7662   //   between types L and R.
7663   //
7664   // C++ [over.built]p24:
7665   //
7666   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
7667   //   candidate operator functions of the form
7668   //
7669   //        LR       operator?(bool, L, R);
7670   //
7671   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7672   //   between types L and R.
7673   // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
7674   void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
7675     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7676       return;
7677 
7678     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7679          Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
7680       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7681            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7682         QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7683                               getArithmeticType(Right) };
7684         QualType Result =
7685           isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
7686                        : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
7687         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
7688       }
7689     }
7690 
7691     // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
7692     // conditional operator for vector types.
7693     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7694               Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7695            Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7696          Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7697       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7698                 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7699              Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7700            Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7701         QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
7702         QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
7703         if (!isComparison) {
7704           if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
7705             Result = *Vec1;
7706           else
7707             Result = *Vec2;
7708         }
7709 
7710         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
7711       }
7712     }
7713   }
7714 
7715   // C++ [over.built]p17:
7716   //
7717   //   For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
7718   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
7719   //
7720   //      LR         operator%(L, R);
7721   //      LR         operator&(L, R);
7722   //      LR         operator^(L, R);
7723   //      LR         operator|(L, R);
7724   //      L          operator<<(L, R);
7725   //      L          operator>>(L, R);
7726   //
7727   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
7728   //   between types L and R.
7729   void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
7730     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7731       return;
7732 
7733     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7734          Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
7735       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7736            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7737         QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
7738                               getArithmeticType(Right) };
7739         QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
7740             ? LandR[0]
7741             : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
7742         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
7743       }
7744     }
7745   }
7746 
7747   // C++ [over.built]p20:
7748   //
7749   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
7750   //   pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
7751   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7752   //
7753   //        VQ T&      operator=(VQ T&, T);
7754   void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
7755     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7756     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7757 
7758     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
7759       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7760                 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
7761              EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
7762            Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
7763         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second)
7764           continue;
7765 
7766         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet);
7767       }
7768 
7769       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7770                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
7771              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
7772            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
7773         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second)
7774           continue;
7775 
7776         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet);
7777       }
7778     }
7779   }
7780 
7781   // C++ [over.built]p19:
7782   //
7783   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
7784   //   volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
7785   //   of the form
7786   //
7787   //        T*VQ&      operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
7788   //
7789   // C++ [over.built]p21:
7790   //
7791   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
7792   //   cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
7793   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7794   //
7795   //        T*VQ&      operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7796   //        T*VQ&      operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
7797   void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7798     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
7799     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
7800 
7801     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7802               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
7803            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
7804          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7805       // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
7806       if (isEqualOp)
7807         AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
7808       else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
7809         continue;
7810 
7811       // non-volatile version
7812       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7813         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7814         isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
7815       };
7816       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7817                             /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
7818 
7819       bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7820                           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7821       if (NeedVolatile) {
7822         // volatile version
7823         ParamTypes[0] =
7824           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
7825         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7826                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7827       }
7828 
7829       if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7830           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7831         // restrict version
7832         ParamTypes[0]
7833           = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7834         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7835                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7836 
7837         if (NeedVolatile) {
7838           // volatile restrict version
7839           ParamTypes[0]
7840             = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7841                 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7842                                               (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7843                                                Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7844           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7845                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7846         }
7847       }
7848     }
7849 
7850     if (isEqualOp) {
7851       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7852                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
7853              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
7854            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
7855         // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
7856         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second)
7857           continue;
7858 
7859         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
7860           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
7861           *Ptr,
7862         };
7863 
7864         // non-volatile version
7865         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7866                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7867 
7868         bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
7869                            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
7870         if (NeedVolatile) {
7871           // volatile version
7872           ParamTypes[0] =
7873             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
7874           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7875                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7876         }
7877 
7878         if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
7879             VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
7880           // restrict version
7881           ParamTypes[0]
7882             = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
7883           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7884                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7885 
7886           if (NeedVolatile) {
7887             // volatile restrict version
7888             ParamTypes[0]
7889               = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
7890                   S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
7891                                                 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
7892                                                  Qualifiers::Restrict)));
7893             S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7894                                   /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
7895           }
7896         }
7897       }
7898     }
7899   }
7900 
7901   // C++ [over.built]p18:
7902   //
7903   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
7904   //   VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
7905   //   arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
7906   //   the form
7907   //
7908   //        VQ L&      operator=(VQ L&, R);
7909   //        VQ L&      operator*=(VQ L&, R);
7910   //        VQ L&      operator/=(VQ L&, R);
7911   //        VQ L&      operator+=(VQ L&, R);
7912   //        VQ L&      operator-=(VQ L&, R);
7913   void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
7914     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7915       return;
7916 
7917     for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
7918       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
7919            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
7920         QualType ParamTypes[2];
7921         ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
7922 
7923         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7924         ParamTypes[0] =
7925           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
7926         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7927                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7928 
7929         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7930         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7931           ParamTypes[0] =
7932             S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
7933           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7934           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7935                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7936         }
7937       }
7938     }
7939 
7940     // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
7941     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7942               Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
7943            Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
7944          Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
7945       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
7946                 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
7947              Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
7948            Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
7949         QualType ParamTypes[2];
7950         ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
7951         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7952         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
7953         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7954                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7955 
7956         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7957         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7958           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
7959           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7960           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
7961                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
7962         }
7963       }
7964     }
7965   }
7966 
7967   // C++ [over.built]p22:
7968   //
7969   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
7970   //   is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
7971   //   type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
7972   //
7973   //        VQ L&       operator%=(VQ L&, R);
7974   //        VQ L&       operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
7975   //        VQ L&       operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
7976   //        VQ L&       operator&=(VQ L&, R);
7977   //        VQ L&       operator^=(VQ L&, R);
7978   //        VQ L&       operator|=(VQ L&, R);
7979   void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
7980     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
7981       return;
7982 
7983     for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
7984       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
7985            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
7986         QualType ParamTypes[2];
7987         ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
7988 
7989         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
7990         ParamTypes[0] =
7991           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
7992         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7993         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
7994           // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
7995           ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
7996           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
7997           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
7998           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
7999         }
8000       }
8001     }
8002   }
8003 
8004   // C++ [over.operator]p23:
8005   //
8006   //   There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
8007   //
8008   //        bool        operator!(bool);
8009   //        bool        operator&&(bool, bool);
8010   //        bool        operator||(bool, bool);
8011   void addExclaimOverload() {
8012     QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
8013     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet,
8014                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
8015                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
8016   }
8017   void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
8018     QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
8019     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8020                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
8021                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
8022   }
8023 
8024   // C++ [over.built]p13:
8025   //
8026   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
8027   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8028   //
8029   //        T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
8030   //        T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
8031   //        T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
8032   //        T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);     [ABOVE]
8033   //        T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
8034   void addSubscriptOverloads() {
8035     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8036               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
8037            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
8038          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8039       QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
8040       QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
8041       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
8042         continue;
8043 
8044       QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
8045 
8046       // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
8047       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8048     }
8049 
8050     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8051               Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
8052            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
8053          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8054       QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
8055       QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
8056       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
8057         continue;
8058 
8059       QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
8060 
8061       // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
8062       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8063     }
8064   }
8065 
8066   // C++ [over.built]p11:
8067   //    For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
8068   //    C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
8069   //    type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
8070   //    there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8071   //
8072   //      CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
8073   //
8074   //    where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
8075   void addArrowStarOverloads() {
8076     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8077              Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
8078            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
8079          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8080       QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
8081       QualType C1;
8082       QualifierCollector Q1;
8083       C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
8084       if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
8085         continue;
8086       // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
8087       // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
8088       // volatile/restrict type.
8089       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
8090         continue;
8091       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
8092         continue;
8093       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8094                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
8095              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
8096            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
8097         const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
8098         QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
8099         C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
8100         if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
8101           break;
8102         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
8103         // build CV12 T&
8104         QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
8105         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
8106             T.isVolatileQualified())
8107           continue;
8108         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
8109             T.isRestrictQualified())
8110           continue;
8111         T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
8112         QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
8113         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8114       }
8115     }
8116   }
8117 
8118   // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
8119   // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
8120   // therefore added as binary.
8121   //
8122   // C++ [over.built]p25:
8123   //   For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
8124   //   enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8125   //
8126   //        T        operator?(bool, T, T);
8127   //
8128   void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
8129     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8130     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8131 
8132     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
8133       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8134                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
8135              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
8136            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8137         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second)
8138           continue;
8139 
8140         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
8141         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8142       }
8143 
8144       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8145                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
8146              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
8147            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
8148         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second)
8149           continue;
8150 
8151         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
8152         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8153       }
8154 
8155       if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
8156         for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8157                   Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
8158                EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
8159              Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
8160           if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
8161             continue;
8162 
8163           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second)
8164             continue;
8165 
8166           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
8167           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8168         }
8169       }
8170     }
8171   }
8172 };
8173 
8174 } // end anonymous namespace
8175 
8176 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
8177 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
8178 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
8179 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
8180 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
8181 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
8182                                         SourceLocation OpLoc,
8183                                         ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8184                                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
8185   // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
8186   // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
8187   // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
8188   // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
8189   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
8190   VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
8191   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
8192     VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
8193 
8194   bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
8195   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
8196   SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
8197   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8198     CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this);
8199     CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
8200                                                  OpLoc,
8201                                                  true,
8202                                                  (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
8203                                                   Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
8204                                                   Op == OO_PipePipe),
8205                                                  VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
8206     HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
8207         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
8208     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
8209         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
8210         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
8211   }
8212 
8213   // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
8214   // for any of the arguments to the operator.
8215   //
8216   // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
8217   // 'bool' overloads.
8218   if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
8219       !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
8220     return;
8221 
8222   // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
8223   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args,
8224                                            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
8225                                            HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
8226                                            CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
8227 
8228   // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
8229   switch (Op) {
8230   case OO_None:
8231   case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
8232     llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
8233 
8234   case OO_New:
8235   case OO_Delete:
8236   case OO_Array_New:
8237   case OO_Array_Delete:
8238   case OO_Call:
8239     llvm_unreachable(
8240                     "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
8241 
8242   case OO_Comma:
8243   case OO_Arrow:
8244   case OO_Coawait:
8245     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8246     //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the
8247     //      operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the
8248     //      built-in candidates set is empty.
8249     break;
8250 
8251   case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
8252     if (Args.size() == 1)
8253       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
8254     // Fall through.
8255 
8256   case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
8257     if (Args.size() == 1) {
8258       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
8259     } else {
8260       OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
8261       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8262     }
8263     break;
8264 
8265   case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
8266     if (Args.size() == 1)
8267       OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
8268     else
8269       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8270     break;
8271 
8272   case OO_Slash:
8273     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8274     break;
8275 
8276   case OO_PlusPlus:
8277   case OO_MinusMinus:
8278     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8279     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
8280     break;
8281 
8282   case OO_EqualEqual:
8283   case OO_ExclaimEqual:
8284     OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
8285     // Fall through.
8286 
8287   case OO_Less:
8288   case OO_Greater:
8289   case OO_LessEqual:
8290   case OO_GreaterEqual:
8291     OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
8292     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
8293     break;
8294 
8295   case OO_Percent:
8296   case OO_Caret:
8297   case OO_Pipe:
8298   case OO_LessLess:
8299   case OO_GreaterGreater:
8300     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8301     break;
8302 
8303   case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
8304     if (Args.size() == 1)
8305       // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8306       //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
8307       //      operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
8308       break;
8309 
8310     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
8311     break;
8312 
8313   case OO_Tilde:
8314     OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
8315     break;
8316 
8317   case OO_Equal:
8318     OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
8319     // Fall through.
8320 
8321   case OO_PlusEqual:
8322   case OO_MinusEqual:
8323     OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
8324     // Fall through.
8325 
8326   case OO_StarEqual:
8327   case OO_SlashEqual:
8328     OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
8329     break;
8330 
8331   case OO_PercentEqual:
8332   case OO_LessLessEqual:
8333   case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
8334   case OO_AmpEqual:
8335   case OO_CaretEqual:
8336   case OO_PipeEqual:
8337     OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
8338     break;
8339 
8340   case OO_Exclaim:
8341     OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
8342     break;
8343 
8344   case OO_AmpAmp:
8345   case OO_PipePipe:
8346     OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
8347     break;
8348 
8349   case OO_Subscript:
8350     OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
8351     break;
8352 
8353   case OO_ArrowStar:
8354     OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
8355     break;
8356 
8357   case OO_Conditional:
8358     OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
8359     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
8360     break;
8361   }
8362 }
8363 
8364 /// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
8365 /// to the set of overloading candidates.
8366 ///
8367 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
8368 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
8369 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
8370 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
8371 void
8372 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
8373                                            SourceLocation Loc,
8374                                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8375                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8376                                            OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
8377                                            bool PartialOverloading) {
8378   ADLResult Fns;
8379 
8380   // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
8381   // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
8382   // which means we need to key off the canonical decl.  However,
8383   // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
8384   // right set of default arguments.  What default arguments are
8385   // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
8386 
8387   // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
8388   ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns);
8389 
8390   // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
8391   for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
8392                                    CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
8393        Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
8394     if (Cand->Function) {
8395       Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
8396       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
8397         Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
8398     }
8399 
8400   // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
8401   // set.
8402   for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8403     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
8404     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
8405       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
8406         continue;
8407 
8408       AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, false,
8409                            PartialOverloading);
8410     } else
8411       AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
8412                                    FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8413                                    Args, CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
8414   }
8415 }
8416 
8417 // Determines whether Cand1 is "better" in terms of its enable_if attrs than
8418 // Cand2 for overloading. This function assumes that all of the enable_if attrs
8419 // on Cand1 and Cand2 have conditions that evaluate to true.
8420 //
8421 // Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff
8422 // Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as
8423 // Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if
8424 // attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes.
8425 static bool hasBetterEnableIfAttrs(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1,
8426                                    const FunctionDecl *Cand2) {
8427 
8428   // FIXME: The next several lines are just
8429   // specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr> but going in declaration order,
8430   // instead of reverse order which is how they're stored in the AST.
8431   auto Cand1Attrs = getOrderedEnableIfAttrs(Cand1);
8432   auto Cand2Attrs = getOrderedEnableIfAttrs(Cand2);
8433 
8434   // Candidate 1 is better if it has strictly more attributes and
8435   // the common sequence is identical.
8436   if (Cand1Attrs.size() <= Cand2Attrs.size())
8437     return false;
8438 
8439   auto Cand1I = Cand1Attrs.begin();
8440   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID;
8441   for (auto &Cand2A : Cand2Attrs) {
8442     Cand1ID.clear();
8443     Cand2ID.clear();
8444 
8445     auto &Cand1A = *Cand1I++;
8446     Cand1A->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true);
8447     Cand2A->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true);
8448     if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID)
8449       return false;
8450   }
8451 
8452   return true;
8453 }
8454 
8455 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
8456 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
8457 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
8458                                       const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
8459                                       SourceLocation Loc,
8460                                       bool UserDefinedConversion) {
8461   // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
8462   // functions.
8463   if (!Cand2.Viable)
8464     return Cand1.Viable;
8465   else if (!Cand1.Viable)
8466     return false;
8467 
8468   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
8469   //
8470   //   -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
8471   //      that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
8472   //      any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
8473   //      better nor worse than ICS1(F).
8474   unsigned StartArg = 0;
8475   if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
8476     StartArg = 1;
8477 
8478   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
8479   //   A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
8480   //   viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
8481   //   conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
8482   unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.NumConversions;
8483   assert(Cand2.NumConversions == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
8484   bool HasBetterConversion = false;
8485   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
8486     switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
8487                                                Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
8488                                                Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
8489     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
8490       // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
8491       HasBetterConversion = true;
8492       break;
8493 
8494     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
8495       // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
8496       return false;
8497 
8498     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
8499       // Do nothing.
8500       break;
8501     }
8502   }
8503 
8504   //    -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
8505   //       ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
8506   if (HasBetterConversion)
8507     return true;
8508 
8509   //   -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
8510   //      (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
8511   //      from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
8512   //      the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
8513   //      conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
8514   //      from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
8515   if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
8516       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
8517       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
8518     // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
8519     // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
8520     // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
8521     // pointer or block.
8522     ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
8523         compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
8524     if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
8525       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
8526                                                   Cand1.FinalConversion,
8527                                                   Cand2.FinalConversion);
8528 
8529     if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
8530       return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
8531 
8532     // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions
8533     // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per
8534     // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3.
8535   }
8536 
8537   //    -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
8538   //       specialization, or, if not that,
8539   bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function &&
8540                                Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
8541   bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function &&
8542                                Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
8543   if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization)
8544     return Cand2IsSpecialization;
8545 
8546   //   -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
8547   //      template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
8548   //      according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
8549   //      if not that,
8550   if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) {
8551     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
8552           = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
8553                                          Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
8554                                          Loc,
8555                        isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
8556                                                              : TPOC_Call,
8557                                          Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments,
8558                                          Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments))
8559       return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
8560   }
8561 
8562   // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution.
8563   if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
8564       (Cand1.Function->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>() ||
8565        Cand2.Function->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>()))
8566     return hasBetterEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
8567 
8568   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && S.getLangOpts().CUDATargetOverloads &&
8569       Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) {
8570     FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
8571     return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) >
8572            S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function);
8573   }
8574 
8575   return false;
8576 }
8577 
8578 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of
8579 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal
8580 /// linkage variable or function is defined by two modules (textually including
8581 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to
8582 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both
8583 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using
8584 /// a modularized libstdc++).
8585 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A,
8586                                                   const NamedDecl *B) {
8587   return A && B && isa<ValueDecl>(A) && isa<ValueDecl>(B) &&
8588          A->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals(
8589              B->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) &&
8590          getOwningModule(const_cast<NamedDecl *>(A)) !=
8591              getOwningModule(const_cast<NamedDecl *>(B)) &&
8592          !A->isExternallyVisible() && !B->isExternallyVisible() &&
8593          Context.hasSameType(cast<ValueDecl>(A)->getType(),
8594                              cast<ValueDecl>(B)->getType());
8595 }
8596 
8597 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(
8598     SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) {
8599   Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D;
8600 
8601   Module *M = getOwningModule(const_cast<NamedDecl*>(D));
8602   Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl)
8603       << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : "");
8604 
8605   for (auto *E : Equiv) {
8606     Module *M = getOwningModule(const_cast<NamedDecl*>(E));
8607     Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl)
8608         << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : "");
8609   }
8610 }
8611 
8612 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8613                                   unsigned NumArgs);
8614 
8615 /// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
8616 /// within an overload candidate set.
8617 ///
8618 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
8619 /// which overload resolution occurs.
8620 ///
8621 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
8622 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
8623 ///
8624 /// \returns The result of overload resolution.
8625 OverloadingResult
8626 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
8627                                          iterator &Best,
8628                                          bool UserDefinedConversion) {
8629   // Find the best viable function.
8630   Best = end();
8631   for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
8632     if (Cand->Viable)
8633       if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
8634                                                      UserDefinedConversion))
8635         Best = Cand;
8636   }
8637 
8638   // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
8639   if (Best == end())
8640     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
8641 
8642   llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands;
8643 
8644   // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
8645   // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
8646   for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
8647     if (Cand->Viable &&
8648         Cand != Best &&
8649         !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
8650                                    UserDefinedConversion)) {
8651       if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Best->Function,
8652                                                    Cand->Function)) {
8653         EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function);
8654         continue;
8655       }
8656 
8657       Best = end();
8658       return OR_Ambiguous;
8659     }
8660   }
8661 
8662   // Best is the best viable function.
8663   if (Best->Function &&
8664       (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
8665        S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
8666     return OR_Deleted;
8667 
8668   if (!EquivalentCands.empty())
8669     S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function,
8670                                                     EquivalentCands);
8671 
8672   return OR_Success;
8673 }
8674 
8675 namespace {
8676 
8677 enum OverloadCandidateKind {
8678   oc_function,
8679   oc_method,
8680   oc_constructor,
8681   oc_function_template,
8682   oc_method_template,
8683   oc_constructor_template,
8684   oc_implicit_default_constructor,
8685   oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
8686   oc_implicit_move_constructor,
8687   oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
8688   oc_implicit_move_assignment,
8689   oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
8690 };
8691 
8692 OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
8693                                                 FunctionDecl *Fn,
8694                                                 std::string &Description) {
8695   bool isTemplate = false;
8696 
8697   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
8698     isTemplate = true;
8699     Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
8700       FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
8701   }
8702 
8703   if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
8704     if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
8705       return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
8706 
8707     if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
8708       return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
8709 
8710     if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
8711       return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
8712 
8713     if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
8714       return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
8715 
8716     assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
8717            "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
8718     return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
8719   }
8720 
8721   if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8722     // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
8723     // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
8724     if (!Meth->isImplicit())
8725       return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
8726 
8727     if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
8728       return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
8729 
8730     if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
8731       return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
8732 
8733     assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
8734     return oc_method;
8735   }
8736 
8737   return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
8738 }
8739 
8740 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *Fn) {
8741   const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
8742   if (!Ctor) return;
8743 
8744   Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
8745   if (!Ctor) return;
8746 
8747   S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
8748 }
8749 
8750 } // end anonymous namespace
8751 
8752 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx,
8753                                     const FunctionDecl *FD) {
8754   for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) {
8755     bool AlwaysTrue;
8756     if (!EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx))
8757       return false;
8758     if (!AlwaysTrue)
8759       return false;
8760   }
8761   return true;
8762 }
8763 
8764 // Notes the location of an overload candidate.
8765 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn, QualType DestType,
8766                                  bool TakingAddress) {
8767   std::string FnDesc;
8768   OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
8769   PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8770                              << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
8771   if (TakingAddress && !isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(Context, Fn))
8772     PD << ft_addr_enable_if;
8773   else
8774     HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
8775   Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
8776   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
8777 }
8778 
8779 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
8780 // OverloadedExpr
8781 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType,
8782                                      bool TakingAddress) {
8783   assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8784 
8785   OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
8786   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
8787 
8788   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8789                             IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8790        I != IEnd; ++I) {
8791     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
8792                 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
8793       NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), DestType,
8794                             TakingAddress);
8795     } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
8796                       = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
8797       NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, DestType, TakingAddress);
8798     }
8799   }
8800 }
8801 
8802 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion.  The partial diagnostic is the
8803 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
8804 /// target types of the conversion.
8805 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
8806                                  Sema &S,
8807                                  SourceLocation CaretLoc,
8808                                  const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
8809   S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
8810     << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
8811   // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
8812   // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
8813   // refactoring here.
8814   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
8815   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
8816   AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
8817   for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
8818     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
8819       break;
8820     ++CandsShown;
8821     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
8822   }
8823   if (I != E)
8824     S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
8825 }
8826 
8827 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
8828                                   unsigned I) {
8829   const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
8830   assert(Conv.isBad());
8831   assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
8832   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
8833 
8834   // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
8835   // non-constructor method.  Note that 'I' corresponds the
8836   // conversion-slot index.
8837   bool isObjectArgument = false;
8838   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
8839     if (I == 0)
8840       isObjectArgument = true;
8841     else
8842       I--;
8843   }
8844 
8845   std::string FnDesc;
8846   OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
8847 
8848   Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
8849   QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
8850   QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
8851 
8852   if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
8853     assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
8854     Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
8855     if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
8856       E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
8857     DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
8858 
8859     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
8860       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8861       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8862       << ToTy << Name << I+1;
8863     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8864     return;
8865   }
8866 
8867   // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
8868   // to a qualifier mismatch.
8869   CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
8870   CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
8871   if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8872     CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
8873   else {
8874     // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
8875     if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8876       if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8877         CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
8878   }
8879 
8880   if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
8881       !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
8882     Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
8883     Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
8884 
8885     if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
8886       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
8887         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8888         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8889         << FromTy
8890         << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
8891         << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8892       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8893       return;
8894     }
8895 
8896     if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
8897       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
8898         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8899         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8900         << FromTy
8901         << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
8902         << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8903       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8904       return;
8905     }
8906 
8907     if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
8908       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
8909       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8910       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8911       << FromTy
8912       << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
8913       << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8914       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8915       return;
8916     }
8917 
8918     unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
8919     assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
8920 
8921     if (isObjectArgument) {
8922       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
8923         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8924         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8925         << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
8926     } else {
8927       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
8928         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8929         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8930         << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
8931     }
8932     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8933     return;
8934   }
8935 
8936   // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
8937   // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
8938   if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
8939     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
8940       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8941       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8942       << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8943     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8944     return;
8945   }
8946 
8947   // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
8948   // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
8949   // the failure.
8950   QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
8951   if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8952     TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
8953   if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
8954     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
8955       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8956       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8957       << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
8958     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8959     return;
8960   }
8961 
8962   // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
8963   unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
8964   if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8965     if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
8966       if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8967                                                FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8968           !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8969           !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8970           S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
8971                           FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
8972         BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
8973     }
8974   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
8975                                     = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8976     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
8977                                         = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
8978       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8979         if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
8980           if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
8981                                                 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
8982               FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
8983             BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
8984   } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
8985     if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
8986         !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
8987         !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
8988         S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
8989       BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
8990     } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
8991                ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
8992                FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
8993       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
8994         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
8995         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
8996         << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1;
8997       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
8998       return;
8999     }
9000   }
9001 
9002   if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
9003     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
9004            diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
9005       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
9006       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
9007       << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
9008       << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
9009     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
9010     return;
9011   }
9012 
9013   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
9014       isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
9015       Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
9016       Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
9017       if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
9018         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
9019         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
9020         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
9021         << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
9022         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
9023         return;
9024       }
9025   }
9026 
9027   // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
9028   PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
9029   FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
9030     << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
9031     << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
9032     << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
9033 
9034   // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
9035   for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
9036        HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
9037     FDiag << *HI;
9038   S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
9039 
9040   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
9041 }
9042 
9043 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload
9044 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch()
9045 /// over a candidate in any candidate set.
9046 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
9047                                unsigned NumArgs) {
9048   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
9049   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
9050 
9051   // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
9052   // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the
9053   // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
9054   // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
9055   // Just don't report anything.
9056   if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
9057       Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
9058     return true;
9059 
9060   if (NumArgs < MinParams) {
9061     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
9062            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
9063             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
9064   } else {
9065     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
9066            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
9067             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
9068   }
9069 
9070   return false;
9071 }
9072 
9073 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set.
9074 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, Decl *D, unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
9075   assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
9076       "The templated declaration should at least be a function"
9077       " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many"
9078       " or too few arguments");
9079 
9080   FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
9081 
9082   // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
9083   const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9084   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
9085 
9086   // at least / at most / exactly
9087   unsigned mode, modeCount;
9088   if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
9089     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() ||
9090         FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
9091       mode = 0; // "at least"
9092     else
9093       mode = 2; // "exactly"
9094     modeCount = MinParams;
9095   } else {
9096     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams())
9097       mode = 1; // "at most"
9098     else
9099       mode = 2; // "exactly"
9100     modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams();
9101   }
9102 
9103   std::string Description;
9104   OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
9105 
9106   if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
9107     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
9108       << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != nullptr)
9109       << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
9110   else
9111     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
9112       << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != nullptr)
9113       << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
9114   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
9115 }
9116 
9117 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate.
9118 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
9119                                   unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
9120   if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs))
9121     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs);
9122 }
9123 
9124 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) {
9125   if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated))
9126     return FD->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
9127   else if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Templated))
9128     return RD->getDescribedClassTemplate();
9129 
9130   llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration"
9131                    " for bad deduction diagnosis");
9132 }
9133 
9134 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
9135 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, Decl *Templated,
9136                                  DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure,
9137                                  unsigned NumArgs) {
9138   TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
9139   NamedDecl *ParamD;
9140   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
9141   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
9142   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
9143   switch (DeductionFailure.Result) {
9144   case Sema::TDK_Success:
9145     llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
9146 
9147   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
9148     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
9149     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9150            diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
9151         << ParamD->getDeclName();
9152     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
9153     return;
9154   }
9155 
9156   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
9157     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
9158     TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
9159 
9160     QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
9161 
9162     // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
9163     // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
9164     QualifierCollector Qs;
9165     Qs.strip(Param);
9166     QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
9167     assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
9168 
9169     // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
9170     // about that.  It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
9171     // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
9172     // done on dependent types).
9173     QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
9174 
9175     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
9176         << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
9177     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
9178     return;
9179   }
9180 
9181   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
9182     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
9183     int which = 0;
9184     if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
9185       which = 0;
9186     else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
9187       which = 1;
9188     else {
9189       which = 2;
9190     }
9191 
9192     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9193            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
9194         << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
9195         << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
9196     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
9197     return;
9198   }
9199 
9200   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
9201     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
9202     if (ParamD->getDeclName())
9203       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9204              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
9205           << ParamD->getDeclName();
9206     else {
9207       int index = 0;
9208       if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
9209         index = TTP->getIndex();
9210       else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
9211                                   = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
9212         index = NTTP->getIndex();
9213       else
9214         index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
9215       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9216              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
9217           << (index + 1);
9218     }
9219     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
9220     return;
9221 
9222   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
9223   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
9224     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Templated, NumArgs);
9225     return;
9226 
9227   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
9228     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9229            diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
9230     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
9231     return;
9232 
9233   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
9234     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
9235     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
9236     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
9237             DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
9238       TemplateArgString = " ";
9239       TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
9240           getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
9241     }
9242 
9243     // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
9244     PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
9245     if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
9246           diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
9247       // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
9248       //        name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
9249       S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
9250         << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
9251       return;
9252     }
9253 
9254     // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
9255     // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
9256     //        formatted message in another diagnostic.
9257     SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
9258     SourceRange R;
9259     if (PDiag) {
9260       SFINAEArgString = ": ";
9261       R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
9262       PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
9263     }
9264 
9265     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9266            diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
9267         << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
9268     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
9269     return;
9270   }
9271 
9272   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution: {
9273     OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(DeductionFailure.getExpr());
9274     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9275            diag::note_ovl_candidate_failed_overload_resolution)
9276         << R.Expression->getName();
9277     return;
9278   }
9279 
9280   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
9281     // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
9282     TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
9283     TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
9284     if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template &&
9285         SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) {
9286       TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate();
9287       TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate();
9288       if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template &&
9289           SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) {
9290         if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() ==
9291             SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) {
9292           // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named
9293           // the same.  This particular case is a bit difficult since:
9294           // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer.
9295           // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better
9296           //    name for types, not decls.
9297           // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer.
9298           S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9299                  diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified)
9300               << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl();
9301           return;
9302         }
9303       }
9304     }
9305     // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda
9306     // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative
9307     // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to
9308     // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters.
9309     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
9310            diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
9311         << FirstTA << SecondTA;
9312     return;
9313   }
9314   // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
9315   // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
9316   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
9317     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
9318     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Templated);
9319     return;
9320   }
9321 }
9322 
9323 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls.
9324 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
9325                                  unsigned NumArgs) {
9326   unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result;
9327   if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) {
9328     if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs))
9329       return;
9330   }
9331   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->Function, // pattern
9332                        Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs);
9333 }
9334 
9335 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
9336 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9337   FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9338   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
9339 
9340   Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
9341                            CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
9342 
9343   std::string FnDesc;
9344   OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
9345 
9346   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
9347       << (unsigned)FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
9348 
9349   // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the
9350   // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case.
9351   CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee);
9352   if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) {
9353     CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent();
9354     Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM;
9355 
9356     switch (FnKind) {
9357     default:
9358       return;
9359     case oc_implicit_default_constructor:
9360       CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor;
9361       break;
9362     case oc_implicit_copy_constructor:
9363       CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor;
9364       break;
9365     case oc_implicit_move_constructor:
9366       CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor;
9367       break;
9368     case oc_implicit_copy_assignment:
9369       CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment;
9370       break;
9371     case oc_implicit_move_assignment:
9372       CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment;
9373       break;
9374     };
9375 
9376     bool ConstRHS = false;
9377     if (Meth->getNumParams()) {
9378       if (const ReferenceType *RT =
9379               Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
9380         ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified();
9381       }
9382     }
9383 
9384     S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth,
9385                                               /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS,
9386                                               /* Diagnose */ true);
9387   }
9388 }
9389 
9390 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9391   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
9392   EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data);
9393 
9394   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
9395          diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr)
9396       << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
9397 }
9398 
9399 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate.  We've
9400 /// already generated a primary error at the call site.
9401 ///
9402 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
9403 /// pointed at the candidate declaration.  Yes, this creates some
9404 /// major challenges of technical writing.  Yes, this makes pointing
9405 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward.  It's still
9406 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
9407 /// overload.
9408 ///
9409 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
9410 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
9411 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
9412 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
9413                                   unsigned NumArgs) {
9414   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
9415 
9416   // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
9417   if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
9418       S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
9419     std::string FnDesc;
9420     OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
9421 
9422     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
9423       << FnKind << FnDesc
9424       << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
9425     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
9426     return;
9427   }
9428 
9429   // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
9430   if (Cand->Viable) {
9431     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
9432     return;
9433   }
9434 
9435   switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
9436   case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
9437   case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
9438     return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
9439 
9440   case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
9441     return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs);
9442 
9443   case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: {
9444     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor)
9445       << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0);
9446     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
9447     return;
9448   }
9449 
9450   case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
9451   case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
9452   case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
9453     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
9454 
9455   case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
9456     unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
9457     for (unsigned N = Cand->NumConversions; I != N; ++I)
9458       if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
9459         return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
9460 
9461     // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
9462     // when user-conversion overload fails.  Figure out how to handle
9463     // those conditions and diagnose them well.
9464     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
9465   }
9466 
9467   case ovl_fail_bad_target:
9468     return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
9469 
9470   case ovl_fail_enable_if:
9471     return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand);
9472   }
9473 }
9474 
9475 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9476   // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
9477   // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
9478   // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
9479   QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
9480   bool isLValueReference = false;
9481   bool isRValueReference = false;
9482   bool isPointer = false;
9483   if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
9484         FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
9485     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
9486     isLValueReference = true;
9487   } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
9488                FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
9489     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
9490     isRValueReference = true;
9491   }
9492   if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
9493     FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9494     isPointer = true;
9495   }
9496   // Desugar down to a function type.
9497   FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
9498   // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
9499   if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
9500   if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
9501   if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
9502 
9503   S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
9504     << FnType;
9505   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
9506 }
9507 
9508 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc,
9509                                          SourceLocation OpLoc,
9510                                          OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9511   assert(Cand->NumConversions <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
9512   std::string TypeStr("operator");
9513   TypeStr += Opc;
9514   TypeStr += "(";
9515   TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
9516   if (Cand->NumConversions == 1) {
9517     TypeStr += ")";
9518     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
9519   } else {
9520     TypeStr += ", ";
9521     TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
9522     TypeStr += ")";
9523     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
9524   }
9525 }
9526 
9527 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
9528                                          OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9529   unsigned NoOperands = Cand->NumConversions;
9530   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
9531     const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
9532     if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
9533     if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
9534 
9535     ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
9536                               S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
9537   }
9538 }
9539 
9540 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9541   if (Cand->Function)
9542     return Cand->Function->getLocation();
9543   if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
9544     return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
9545   return SourceLocation();
9546 }
9547 
9548 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
9549   switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
9550   case Sema::TDK_Success:
9551     llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
9552 
9553   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
9554   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
9555     return 1;
9556 
9557   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
9558   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
9559     return 2;
9560 
9561   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
9562   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
9563   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
9564     return 3;
9565 
9566   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
9567   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
9568     return 4;
9569 
9570   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
9571     return 5;
9572 
9573   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
9574   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
9575     return 6;
9576   }
9577   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
9578 }
9579 
9580 namespace {
9581 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
9582   Sema &S;
9583   size_t NumArgs;
9584 
9585   CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S, size_t nArgs)
9586       : S(S), NumArgs(nArgs) {}
9587 
9588   bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
9589                   const OverloadCandidate *R) {
9590     // Fast-path this check.
9591     if (L == R) return false;
9592 
9593     // Order first by viability.
9594     if (L->Viable) {
9595       if (!R->Viable) return true;
9596 
9597       // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
9598       // candidates.  Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
9599       // that could exploit it.
9600       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
9601       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
9602     } else if (R->Viable)
9603       return false;
9604 
9605     assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
9606 
9607     // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
9608     if (!L->Viable) {
9609       // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
9610       if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
9611           L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
9612         if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
9613             R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
9614           int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
9615           int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
9616           if (LDist == RDist) {
9617             if (L->FailureKind == R->FailureKind)
9618               // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates.
9619               return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate;
9620             // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were
9621             // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters
9622             // than there were arguments given.
9623             return L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
9624           }
9625           return LDist < RDist;
9626         }
9627         return false;
9628       }
9629       if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
9630           R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
9631         return true;
9632 
9633       // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
9634       // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
9635       if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
9636         if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
9637           return true;
9638 
9639         // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
9640         // comes first.
9641         unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
9642         unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
9643         numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
9644         numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
9645         if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
9646           return numLFixes < numRFixes;
9647         }
9648 
9649         // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
9650         // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
9651         assert(L->NumConversions == R->NumConversions);
9652 
9653         int leftBetter = 0;
9654         unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
9655         for (unsigned E = L->NumConversions; I != E; ++I) {
9656           switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
9657                                                      L->Conversions[I],
9658                                                      R->Conversions[I])) {
9659           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
9660             leftBetter++;
9661             break;
9662 
9663           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
9664             leftBetter--;
9665             break;
9666 
9667           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
9668             break;
9669           }
9670         }
9671         if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
9672         if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
9673 
9674       } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
9675         return false;
9676 
9677       if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
9678         if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
9679           return true;
9680 
9681         if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
9682           return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
9683                < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
9684       } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
9685         return false;
9686 
9687       // TODO: others?
9688     }
9689 
9690     // Sort everything else by location.
9691     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
9692     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
9693 
9694     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
9695     if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
9696     if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
9697 
9698     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
9699   }
9700 };
9701 }
9702 
9703 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
9704 /// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
9705 static void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
9706                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
9707   assert(!Cand->Viable);
9708 
9709   // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
9710   if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
9711 
9712   // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
9713   bool Unfixable = false;
9714   // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
9715   Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
9716 
9717   // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
9718   unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
9719   unsigned ConvCount = Cand->NumConversions;
9720   while (true) {
9721     assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
9722     ConvIdx++;
9723     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
9724       Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
9725       break;
9726     }
9727   }
9728 
9729   if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
9730     return;
9731 
9732   assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
9733          "remaining conversion is initialized?");
9734 
9735   // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
9736   // operation somehow.
9737   bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
9738 
9739   const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
9740   unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
9741 
9742   if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
9743     QualType ConvType
9744       = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
9745     if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
9746       ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
9747     Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9748     ArgIdx--;
9749   } else if (Cand->Function) {
9750     Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9751     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
9752         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
9753       ArgIdx--;
9754   } else {
9755     // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
9756     assert(ConvCount <= 3);
9757     for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
9758       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
9759         = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
9760                                 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
9761                                 SuppressUserConversions,
9762                                 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
9763                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
9764                                   S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
9765     return;
9766   }
9767 
9768   // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
9769   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
9770   for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
9771     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
9772       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization(
9773           S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx), SuppressUserConversions,
9774           /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
9775           /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
9776           S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
9777       // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
9778       if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
9779         Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
9780     }
9781     else
9782       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
9783   }
9784 }
9785 
9786 /// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
9787 /// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
9788 /// set.
9789 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
9790                                           OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
9791                                           ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
9792                                           StringRef Opc,
9793                                           SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9794   // Sort the candidates by viability and position.  Sorting directly would
9795   // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
9796   SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
9797   if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
9798   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
9799     if (Cand->Viable)
9800       Cands.push_back(Cand);
9801     else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
9802       CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args);
9803       if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
9804         Cands.push_back(Cand);
9805       // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate.  We do not, in general,
9806       // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
9807     }
9808   }
9809 
9810   std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
9811             CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, Args.size()));
9812 
9813   bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
9814 
9815   SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
9816   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
9817   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
9818   for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9819     OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
9820 
9821     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
9822     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
9823     // candidate list.
9824     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
9825       break;
9826     }
9827     ++CandsShown;
9828 
9829     if (Cand->Function)
9830       NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size());
9831     else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
9832       NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
9833     else {
9834       assert(Cand->Viable &&
9835              "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
9836       // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
9837       // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
9838       // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
9839       //
9840       // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
9841       // different ambiguities, though.
9842       if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
9843         NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
9844         ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
9845       }
9846 
9847       // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
9848       NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
9849     }
9850   }
9851 
9852   if (I != E)
9853     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
9854 }
9855 
9856 static SourceLocation
9857 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) {
9858   return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation()
9859                               : SourceLocation();
9860 }
9861 
9862 namespace {
9863 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay {
9864   Sema &S;
9865   CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
9866 
9867   bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L,
9868                   const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) {
9869     // Fast-path this check.
9870     if (L == R)
9871       return false;
9872 
9873     // Assuming that both candidates are not matches...
9874 
9875     // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures.
9876     if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
9877       return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) <
9878              RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
9879 
9880     // Sort everything else by location.
9881     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
9882     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
9883 
9884     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
9885     if (LLoc.isInvalid())
9886       return false;
9887     if (RLoc.isInvalid())
9888       return true;
9889 
9890     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
9891   }
9892 };
9893 }
9894 
9895 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure.
9896 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad
9897 /// deductions.
9898 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S) {
9899   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Specialization, // pattern
9900                        DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0);
9901 }
9902 
9903 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
9904   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
9905     i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
9906   }
9907 }
9908 
9909 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() {
9910   destroyCandidates();
9911   Candidates.clear();
9912 }
9913 
9914 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints
9915 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form
9916 /// the candidate set.
9917 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with
9918 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false.
9919 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
9920   // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match).
9921   // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers
9922   // and sort those.
9923   SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands;
9924   Cands.reserve(size());
9925   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
9926     if (Cand->Specialization)
9927       Cands.push_back(Cand);
9928     // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate.  We do not,
9929     // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate.
9930   }
9931 
9932   std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
9933             CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S));
9934 
9935   // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads()
9936   // for generalization purposes (?).
9937   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
9938 
9939   SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E;
9940   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
9941   for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9942     TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I;
9943 
9944     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam
9945     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
9946     // candidate list.
9947     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
9948       break;
9949     ++CandsShown;
9950 
9951     assert(Cand->Specialization &&
9952            "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
9953     Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S);
9954   }
9955 
9956   if (I != E)
9957     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
9958 }
9959 
9960 // [PossiblyAFunctionType]  -->   [Return]
9961 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
9962 // R (A) --> R(A)
9963 // R (*)(A) --> R (A)
9964 // R (&)(A) --> R (A)
9965 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
9966 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
9967   QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
9968   if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
9969     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
9970     Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9971   else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
9972     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
9973     Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
9974   else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
9975     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
9976     Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
9977   Ret =
9978     Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
9979   return Ret;
9980 }
9981 
9982 namespace {
9983 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution
9984 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
9985 class AddressOfFunctionResolver {
9986   Sema& S;
9987   Expr* SourceExpr;
9988   const QualType& TargetType;
9989   QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
9990 
9991   bool Complain;
9992   //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
9993   ASTContext& Context;
9994 
9995   bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
9996   bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
9997   bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
9998   bool HasComplained;
9999 
10000   OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
10001   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
10002   TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
10003   SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
10004   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates;
10005 
10006 public:
10007   AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr,
10008                             const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain)
10009       : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
10010         Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
10011         TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
10012             !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
10013         FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
10014         StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false),
10015         HasComplained(false),
10016         OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
10017         OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression),
10018         FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc()) {
10019     ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
10020 
10021     if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
10022       if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr))
10023         if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() &&
10024             !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME))
10025           StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true;
10026     } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10027       DeclAccessPair dap;
10028       if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
10029               OvlExpr, false, &dap)) {
10030         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn))
10031           if (!Method->isStatic()) {
10032             // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found
10033             // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the
10034             // target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
10035             TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
10036 
10037             // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
10038             // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
10039             if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
10040               return;
10041           }
10042 
10043         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn));
10044       }
10045       return;
10046     }
10047 
10048     if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
10049       OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
10050 
10051     if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
10052       // C++ [over.over]p4:
10053       //   If more than one function is selected, [...]
10054       if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) {
10055         if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
10056           EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
10057         else
10058           EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
10059       }
10060     }
10061 
10062     if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && S.getLangOpts().CUDATargetOverloads &&
10063         Matches.size() > 1)
10064       EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches();
10065   }
10066 
10067   bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; }
10068 
10069 private:
10070   // Is A considered a better overload candidate for the desired type than B?
10071   bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) {
10072     return hasBetterEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B);
10073   }
10074 
10075   // Returns true if we've eliminated any (read: all but one) candidates, false
10076   // otherwise.
10077   bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() {
10078     // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best",
10079     // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best.
10080     auto Best = Matches.begin();
10081     for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I)
10082       if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second))
10083         Best = I;
10084 
10085     const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second;
10086     auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn](
10087         const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) {
10088       return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second);
10089     };
10090 
10091     // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best
10092     // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error
10093     if (!std::all_of(Matches.begin(), Matches.end(), IsBestOrInferiorToBest))
10094       return false;
10095     Matches[0] = *Best;
10096     Matches.resize(1);
10097     return true;
10098   }
10099 
10100   bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
10101     return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
10102   }
10103 
10104   // [ToType]     [Return]
10105 
10106   // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
10107   // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
10108   // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
10109   void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
10110     TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
10111   }
10112 
10113   // return true if any matching specializations were found
10114   bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
10115                                    const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
10116     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
10117               = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
10118       // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
10119       // static when converting to member pointer.
10120       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
10121         return false;
10122     }
10123     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
10124       return false;
10125 
10126     // C++ [over.over]p2:
10127     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
10128     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
10129     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
10130     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
10131     //   overloaded functions considered.
10132     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
10133     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
10134     if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
10135           = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
10136                                       &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
10137                                       TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
10138                                       Info, /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
10139       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
10140       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
10141           .set(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
10142                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
10143       return false;
10144     }
10145 
10146     // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or
10147     // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS.
10148     // This function template specicalization works.
10149     Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
10150     assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(
10151               Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()),
10152               Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType)) ||
10153            (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TargetType->isVoidPointerType()));
10154 
10155     if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, Specialization))
10156       return false;
10157 
10158     Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
10159     return true;
10160   }
10161 
10162   bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
10163                                       const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
10164     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
10165       // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
10166       // when converting to member pointer.
10167       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
10168         return false;
10169     }
10170     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
10171       return false;
10172 
10173     if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
10174       if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
10175         if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
10176           if (!Caller->isImplicit() && S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
10177             return false;
10178 
10179       // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction
10180       // now.
10181       if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 &&
10182           FunDecl->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
10183           S.DeduceReturnType(FunDecl, SourceExpr->getLocStart(), Complain)) {
10184         HasComplained |= Complain;
10185         return false;
10186       }
10187 
10188       if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FunDecl))
10189         return false;
10190 
10191       QualType ResultTy;
10192       if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
10193                                          FunDecl->getType()) ||
10194           S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
10195                                  ResultTy) ||
10196           (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && TargetType->isVoidPointerType())) {
10197         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(
10198             CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
10199         FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
10200         return true;
10201       }
10202     }
10203 
10204     return false;
10205   }
10206 
10207   bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
10208     bool Ret = false;
10209 
10210     // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
10211     // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
10212     if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
10213       return false;
10214 
10215     for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
10216                                E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
10217          I != E; ++I) {
10218       // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
10219       NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
10220 
10221       // C++ [over.over]p3:
10222       //   Non-member functions and static member functions match
10223       //   targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
10224       //   Nonstatic member functions match targets of
10225       //   type "pointer-to-member-function."
10226       // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
10227       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
10228                                         = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
10229         if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
10230           Ret = true;
10231       }
10232       // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
10233       else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
10234                AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
10235         Ret = true;
10236     }
10237     assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
10238     return Ret;
10239   }
10240 
10241   void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
10242     //   [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
10243     //   eliminated if the set contains a second function template
10244     //   specialization whose function template is more specialized
10245     //   than the function template of F1 according to the partial
10246     //   ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
10247 
10248     // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
10249     // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
10250     // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
10251     // best function template (if it exists).
10252 
10253     UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
10254     for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
10255       MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
10256 
10257     // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose
10258     // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0.
10259     UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized(
10260         MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates,
10261         SourceExpr->getLocStart(), S.PDiag(),
10262         S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous) << Matches[0]
10263                                                      .second->getDeclName(),
10264         S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate) << (unsigned)oc_function_template,
10265         Complain, TargetFunctionType);
10266 
10267     if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
10268       // Make it the first and only element
10269       Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
10270       Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
10271       Matches.resize(1);
10272     } else
10273       HasComplained |= Complain;
10274   }
10275 
10276   void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
10277     //   [...] any function template specializations in the set are
10278     //   eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
10279     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
10280       if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr)
10281         ++I;
10282       else {
10283         Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
10284         Matches.resize(N);
10285       }
10286     }
10287   }
10288 
10289   void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() {
10290     S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches);
10291   }
10292 
10293 public:
10294   void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
10295     assert(Matches.empty());
10296     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
10297         << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
10298         << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
10299     if (FailedCandidates.empty())
10300       S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType,
10301                                   /*TakingAddress=*/true);
10302     else {
10303       // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose
10304       // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates
10305       // normally.
10306       for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
10307                                  IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
10308            I != IEnd; ++I)
10309         if (FunctionDecl *Fun =
10310                 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
10311           S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun, TargetFunctionType,
10312                                   /*TakingAddress=*/true);
10313       FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getLocStart());
10314     }
10315   }
10316 
10317   bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
10318     return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
10319       !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
10320   }
10321 
10322   void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
10323       // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
10324       // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
10325       // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
10326       S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
10327         << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
10328   }
10329 
10330   bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
10331     return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
10332   }
10333 
10334   void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
10335     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(),
10336            diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
10337       << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
10338   }
10339 
10340   void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
10341     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
10342       << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
10343   }
10344 
10345   void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
10346     assert(Matches.size() > 1);
10347     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
10348       << OvlExpr->getName()
10349       << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
10350     S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType,
10351                                 /*TakingAddress=*/true);
10352   }
10353 
10354   bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
10355 
10356   int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
10357 
10358   FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
10359     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
10360     return Matches[0].second;
10361   }
10362 
10363   const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
10364     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
10365     return &Matches[0].first;
10366   }
10367 };
10368 }
10369 
10370 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
10371 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
10372 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
10373 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
10374 ///
10375 /// @code
10376 /// int f(double);
10377 /// int f(int);
10378 ///
10379 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
10380 /// @endcode
10381 ///
10382 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
10383 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
10384 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
10385 FunctionDecl *
10386 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
10387                                          QualType TargetType,
10388                                          bool Complain,
10389                                          DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
10390                                          bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
10391   assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10392 
10393   AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
10394                                      Complain);
10395   int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
10396   FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr;
10397   bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained();
10398   if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) {
10399     if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
10400       Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
10401     else
10402       Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
10403   }
10404   else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain)
10405     Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
10406   else if (NumMatches == 1) {
10407     Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
10408     assert(Fn);
10409     FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
10410     if (Complain) {
10411       if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer())
10412         Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer();
10413       else
10414         CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
10415     }
10416   }
10417 
10418   if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
10419     *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
10420   return Fn;
10421 }
10422 
10423 /// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
10424 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
10425 ///
10426 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
10427 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
10428 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
10429 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
10430 ///
10431 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is
10432 /// returned.
10433 FunctionDecl *
10434 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
10435                                                   bool Complain,
10436                                                   DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
10437   // C++ [over.over]p1:
10438   //   [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
10439   //   overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
10440   // C++ [over.over]p1:
10441   //   [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
10442   //   operator.
10443 
10444   // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
10445   if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
10446     return nullptr;
10447 
10448   TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
10449   ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
10450   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc());
10451 
10452   // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
10453   // whose type matches exactly.
10454   FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr;
10455   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
10456          E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10457     // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
10458     //   [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
10459     //   where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
10460     //   specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
10461     //   identifies a single function template specialization, then the
10462     //   template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
10463     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
10464       = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
10465 
10466     // C++ [over.over]p2:
10467     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
10468     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
10469     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
10470     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
10471     //   overloaded functions considered.
10472     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
10473     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
10474     if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
10475           = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
10476                                     Specialization, Info,
10477                                     /*InOverloadResolution=*/true)) {
10478       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
10479       // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info?
10480       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
10481           .set(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
10482                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
10483       continue;
10484     }
10485 
10486     assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
10487 
10488     // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
10489     if (Matched) {
10490       if (Complain) {
10491         Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
10492           << ovl->getName();
10493         NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
10494       }
10495       return nullptr;
10496     }
10497 
10498     Matched = Specialization;
10499     if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
10500   }
10501 
10502   if (Matched && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 &&
10503       Matched->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
10504       DeduceReturnType(Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain))
10505     return nullptr;
10506 
10507   return Matched;
10508 }
10509 
10510 
10511 
10512 
10513 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
10514 // because it identifies a single function template specialization.
10515 //
10516 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
10517 //
10518 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
10519 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded.  Always
10520 // returns true if 'complain' is set.
10521 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
10522                       ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
10523                       bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining,
10524                                            QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
10525                                             unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
10526   assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10527 
10528   OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
10529 
10530   DeclAccessPair found;
10531   ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
10532   if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
10533                            ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
10534     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getLocStart())) {
10535       SrcExpr = ExprError();
10536       return true;
10537     }
10538 
10539     // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
10540     // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
10541     // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
10542     // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
10543     if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
10544         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
10545         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
10546       if (!complain) return false;
10547 
10548       Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
10549            diag::err_bound_member_function)
10550         << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
10551 
10552       // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
10553       // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
10554       // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
10555       // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
10556       // the static candidates were rejected.
10557       SrcExpr = ExprError();
10558       return true;
10559     }
10560 
10561     // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
10562     SingleFunctionExpression =
10563         FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn);
10564 
10565     // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
10566     if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
10567       SingleFunctionExpression =
10568         DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get());
10569       if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
10570         SrcExpr = ExprError();
10571         return true;
10572       }
10573     }
10574   }
10575 
10576   if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
10577     if (complain) {
10578       Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
10579         << ovl.Expression->getName()
10580         << DestTypeForComplaining
10581         << OpRangeForComplaining
10582         << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
10583       NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
10584 
10585       SrcExpr = ExprError();
10586       return true;
10587     }
10588 
10589     return false;
10590   }
10591 
10592   SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
10593   return true;
10594 }
10595 
10596 /// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
10597 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
10598                                        DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
10599                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
10600                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10601                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10602                                        bool PartialOverloading,
10603                                        bool KnownValid) {
10604   NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
10605   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
10606     Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
10607 
10608   if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
10609     if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
10610       assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
10611       return;
10612     }
10613     S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
10614                            /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false,
10615                            PartialOverloading);
10616     return;
10617   }
10618 
10619   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
10620       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
10621     S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
10622                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet,
10623                                    /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false,
10624                                    PartialOverloading);
10625     return;
10626   }
10627 
10628   assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
10629 }
10630 
10631 /// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
10632 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
10633 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10634                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10635                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
10636                                        bool PartialOverloading) {
10637 
10638 #ifndef NDEBUG
10639   // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
10640   // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
10641   //
10642   //   Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
10643   //   and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
10644   //   lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
10645   //
10646   //     -- a declaration of a class member, or
10647   //
10648   //     -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
10649   //        using-declaration, or
10650   //
10651   //     -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
10652   //        template
10653   //
10654   //   then Y is empty.
10655 
10656   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
10657     for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
10658            E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
10659       assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
10660       assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
10661              !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
10662       assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
10663     }
10664   }
10665 #endif
10666 
10667   // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
10668   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
10669   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
10670   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10671     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
10672     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
10673   }
10674 
10675   for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
10676          E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
10677     AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
10678                                CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
10679                                /*KnownValid*/ true);
10680 
10681   if (ULE->requiresADL())
10682     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(),
10683                                          Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
10684                                          CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
10685 }
10686 
10687 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into
10688 /// a different namespace.
10689 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) {
10690   switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) {
10691   case OO_New: case OO_Array_New:
10692   case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete:
10693     return false;
10694 
10695   default:
10696     return true;
10697   }
10698 }
10699 
10700 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
10701 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
10702 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
10703 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
10704 ///
10705 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
10706 static bool
10707 DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
10708                        const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
10709                        OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK,
10710                        TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
10711                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10712                        bool *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = nullptr) {
10713   if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
10714     return false;
10715 
10716   for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
10717     if (DC->isTransparentContext())
10718       continue;
10719 
10720     SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
10721 
10722     if (!R.empty()) {
10723       R.suppressDiagnostics();
10724 
10725       if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
10726         // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
10727         // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
10728         R.clear();
10729         if (DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup)
10730           *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = true;
10731         return false;
10732       }
10733 
10734       OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK);
10735       for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
10736         AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
10737                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
10738                                    Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
10739 
10740       OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
10741       if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
10742         // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
10743         // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
10744         R.clear();
10745         return false;
10746       }
10747 
10748       // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
10749       // declaring the function there instead.
10750       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
10751       Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
10752       SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
10753                                                  AssociatedNamespaces,
10754                                                  AssociatedClasses);
10755       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
10756       if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) {
10757         DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
10758         for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
10759                it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
10760                end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
10761           // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
10762           if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
10763             continue;
10764 
10765           // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a
10766           // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx.
10767           NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
10768           if (NS &&
10769               NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
10770             continue;
10771 
10772           SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
10773         }
10774       }
10775 
10776       SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10777         << R.getLookupName();
10778       if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
10779         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10780                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10781           << R.getLookupName() << 0;
10782       } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
10783         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10784                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10785           << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
10786       } else {
10787         // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
10788         // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
10789         // a localized representation of a list of items.
10790         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
10791                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
10792           << R.getLookupName() << 2;
10793       }
10794 
10795       // Try to recover by calling this function.
10796       return true;
10797     }
10798 
10799     R.clear();
10800   }
10801 
10802   return false;
10803 }
10804 
10805 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
10806 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
10807 /// was defined.
10808 ///
10809 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
10810 static bool
10811 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
10812                                SourceLocation OpLoc,
10813                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
10814   DeclarationName OpName =
10815     SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
10816   LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
10817   return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
10818                                 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
10819                                 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args);
10820 }
10821 
10822 namespace {
10823 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
10824   Sema &SemaRef;
10825 public:
10826   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
10827     assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
10828     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
10829   }
10830 
10831   ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
10832     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
10833   }
10834 };
10835 
10836 }
10837 
10838 static std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback>
10839 MakeValidator(Sema &SemaRef, MemberExpr *ME, size_t NumArgs,
10840               bool HasTemplateArgs, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10841   if (!AllowTypoCorrection)
10842     return llvm::make_unique<NoTypoCorrectionCCC>();
10843   return llvm::make_unique<FunctionCallFilterCCC>(SemaRef, NumArgs,
10844                                                   HasTemplateArgs, ME);
10845 }
10846 
10847 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
10848 ///
10849 /// Returns true if new candidates were found.
10850 static ExprResult
10851 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10852                       UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10853                       SourceLocation LParenLoc,
10854                       MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
10855                       SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10856                       bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10857   // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
10858   // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
10859   //
10860   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
10861   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
10862   //
10863   if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
10864     return ExprError();
10865   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
10866 
10867   CXXScopeSpec SS;
10868   SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
10869   SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
10870 
10871   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
10872   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
10873   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10874     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
10875     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
10876   }
10877 
10878   LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
10879                  Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
10880   bool DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = EmptyLookup;
10881   if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
10882                               OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal,
10883                               ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
10884                               &DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup) &&
10885     (!DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup || SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(
10886         S, SS, R,
10887         MakeValidator(SemaRef, dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn), Args.size(),
10888                       ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr, AllowTypoCorrection),
10889         ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args)))
10890     return ExprError();
10891 
10892   assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
10893 
10894   // Build an implicit member call if appropriate.  Just drop the
10895   // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
10896   ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
10897   if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
10898     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R,
10899                                                     ExplicitTemplateArgs, S);
10900   else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
10901     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
10902                                         ExplicitTemplateArgs);
10903   else
10904     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
10905 
10906   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
10907     return ExprError();
10908 
10909   // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
10910   // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
10911   // end up here.
10912   return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc,
10913                                MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()),
10914                                RParenLoc);
10915 }
10916 
10917 /// \brief Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
10918 /// the given function.
10919 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
10920 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10921                                   UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10922                                   MultiExprArg Args,
10923                                   SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10924                                   OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10925                                   ExprResult *Result) {
10926 #ifndef NDEBUG
10927   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
10928     // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
10929     assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
10930 
10931     // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
10932     // Verify that this was correctly set up.
10933     FunctionDecl *F;
10934     if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
10935         (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
10936         F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
10937       llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
10938 
10939     // We don't perform ADL in C.
10940     assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
10941   }
10942 #endif
10943 
10944   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
10945   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) {
10946     *Result = ExprError();
10947     return true;
10948   }
10949 
10950   // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
10951   // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
10952   AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet);
10953 
10954   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
10955       CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() &&
10956       (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
10957 
10958     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
10959     if (CandidateSet->empty() ||
10960         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best) ==
10961             OR_No_Viable_Function) {
10962       // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
10963       // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
10964       // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
10965       // classes.
10966       CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(
10967           Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
10968       CE->setTypeDependent(true);
10969       CE->setValueDependent(true);
10970       CE->setInstantiationDependent(true);
10971       *Result = CE;
10972       return true;
10973     }
10974   }
10975 
10976   if (CandidateSet->empty())
10977     return false;
10978 
10979   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
10980   return false;
10981 }
10982 
10983 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
10984 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
10985 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
10986 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
10987                                            UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
10988                                            SourceLocation LParenLoc,
10989                                            MultiExprArg Args,
10990                                            SourceLocation RParenLoc,
10991                                            Expr *ExecConfig,
10992                                            OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
10993                                            OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
10994                                            OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
10995                                            bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
10996   if (CandidateSet->empty())
10997     return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
10998                                  RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
10999                                  AllowTypoCorrection);
11000 
11001   switch (OverloadResult) {
11002   case OR_Success: {
11003     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
11004     SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
11005     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()))
11006       return ExprError();
11007     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
11008     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
11009                                          ExecConfig);
11010   }
11011 
11012   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
11013     // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
11014     // have meant to call.
11015     ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
11016                                                 Args, RParenLoc,
11017                                                 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
11018                                                 AllowTypoCorrection);
11019     if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
11020       return Recovery;
11021 
11022     SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
11023          diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
11024       << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
11025     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11026     break;
11027   }
11028 
11029   case OR_Ambiguous:
11030     SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
11031       << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
11032     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
11033     break;
11034 
11035   case OR_Deleted: {
11036     SemaRef.Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
11037       << (*Best)->Function->isDeleted()
11038       << ULE->getName()
11039       << SemaRef.getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix((*Best)->Function)
11040       << Fn->getSourceRange();
11041     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11042 
11043     // We emitted an error for the unvailable/deleted function call but keep
11044     // the call in the AST.
11045     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
11046     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
11047     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
11048                                          ExecConfig);
11049   }
11050   }
11051 
11052   // Overload resolution failed.
11053   return ExprError();
11054 }
11055 
11056 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
11057 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
11058 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
11059 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
11060 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
11061 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
11062 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
11063                                          UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
11064                                          SourceLocation LParenLoc,
11065                                          MultiExprArg Args,
11066                                          SourceLocation RParenLoc,
11067                                          Expr *ExecConfig,
11068                                          bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
11069   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(),
11070                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
11071   ExprResult result;
11072 
11073   if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet,
11074                              &result))
11075     return result;
11076 
11077   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11078   OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
11079       CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
11080 
11081   return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
11082                                   RParenLoc, ExecConfig, &CandidateSet,
11083                                   &Best, OverloadResult,
11084                                   AllowTypoCorrection);
11085 }
11086 
11087 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
11088   return Functions.size() > 1 ||
11089     (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
11090 }
11091 
11092 /// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
11093 /// operator.
11094 ///
11095 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
11096 ///
11097 /// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
11098 /// operator.
11099 ///
11100 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
11101 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
11102 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
11103 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
11104 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
11105 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
11106 ///
11107 /// \param Input The input argument.
11108 ExprResult
11109 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
11110                               const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
11111                               Expr *Input) {
11112   UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
11113 
11114   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
11115   assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
11116   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
11117   // TODO: provide better source location info.
11118   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
11119 
11120   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
11121     return ExprError();
11122 
11123   Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr };
11124   unsigned NumArgs = 1;
11125 
11126   // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
11127   // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
11128   // post-decrement.
11129   if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
11130     llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
11131     Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
11132                                      SourceLocation());
11133     NumArgs = 2;
11134   }
11135 
11136   ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs);
11137 
11138   if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
11139     if (Fns.empty())
11140       return new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy,
11141                                          VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc);
11142 
11143     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
11144     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
11145       = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
11146                                      NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
11147                                      /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
11148                                      Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
11149     return new (Context)
11150         CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, ArgsArray, Context.DependentTy,
11151                             VK_RValue, OpLoc, false);
11152   }
11153 
11154   // Build an empty overload set.
11155   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
11156 
11157   // Add the candidates from the given function set.
11158   AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
11159 
11160   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
11161   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
11162 
11163   // Add candidates from ADL.
11164   AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray,
11165                                        /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr,
11166                                        CandidateSet);
11167 
11168   // Add builtin operator candidates.
11169   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
11170 
11171   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11172 
11173   // Perform overload resolution.
11174   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11175   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
11176   case OR_Success: {
11177     // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
11178     FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
11179 
11180     if (FnDecl) {
11181       // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
11182       // operator.
11183 
11184       // Convert the arguments.
11185       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
11186         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
11187 
11188         ExprResult InputRes =
11189           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
11190                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11191         if (InputRes.isInvalid())
11192           return ExprError();
11193         Input = InputRes.get();
11194       } else {
11195         // Convert the arguments.
11196         ExprResult InputInit
11197           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
11198                                                       Context,
11199                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
11200                                       SourceLocation(),
11201                                       Input);
11202         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
11203           return ExprError();
11204         Input = InputInit.get();
11205       }
11206 
11207       // Build the actual expression node.
11208       ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
11209                                                 HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
11210       if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11211         return ExprError();
11212 
11213       // Determine the result type.
11214       QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
11215       ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11216       ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11217 
11218       Args[0] = Input;
11219       CallExpr *TheCall =
11220         new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray,
11221                                           ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
11222 
11223       if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
11224         return ExprError();
11225 
11226       return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
11227     } else {
11228       // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
11229       // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
11230       // operator node.
11231       ExprResult InputRes =
11232         PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
11233                                   Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
11234       if (InputRes.isInvalid())
11235         return ExprError();
11236       Input = InputRes.get();
11237       break;
11238     }
11239   }
11240 
11241   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11242     // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
11243     // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
11244     // defined too late to be candidates.
11245     if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray))
11246       // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
11247       return ExprError();
11248 
11249     // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
11250     // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
11251     break;
11252 
11253   case OR_Ambiguous:
11254     Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
11255         << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
11256         << Input->getType()
11257         << Input->getSourceRange();
11258     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, ArgsArray,
11259                                 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
11260     return ExprError();
11261 
11262   case OR_Deleted:
11263     Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11264       << Best->Function->isDeleted()
11265       << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
11266       << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
11267       << Input->getSourceRange();
11268     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray,
11269                                 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
11270     return ExprError();
11271   }
11272 
11273   // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
11274   // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
11275   // build a built-in operation.
11276   return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
11277 }
11278 
11279 /// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
11280 /// operator.
11281 ///
11282 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
11283 ///
11284 /// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
11285 /// operator.
11286 ///
11287 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
11288 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
11289 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
11290 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
11291 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
11292 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
11293 ///
11294 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
11295 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
11296 ExprResult
11297 Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
11298                             unsigned OpcIn,
11299                             const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
11300                             Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
11301   Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
11302   LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
11303 
11304   BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
11305   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
11306   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
11307 
11308   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
11309   // expression.
11310   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
11311     if (Fns.empty()) {
11312       // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
11313       // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
11314       if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
11315         return new (Context) BinaryOperator(
11316             Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
11317             OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
11318 
11319       return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(
11320           Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary,
11321           Context.DependentTy, Context.DependentTy, OpLoc,
11322           FPFeatures.fp_contract);
11323     }
11324 
11325     // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
11326     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
11327     // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
11328     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
11329     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
11330       = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
11331                                      NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
11332                                      /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
11333                                      Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
11334     return new (Context)
11335         CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy,
11336                             VK_RValue, OpLoc, FPFeatures.fp_contract);
11337   }
11338 
11339   // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
11340   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
11341     return ExprError();
11342 
11343   // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
11344   // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
11345   assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
11346   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
11347     return ExprError();
11348 
11349   // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
11350   // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
11351   // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
11352   // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
11353   // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
11354   // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
11355   if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
11356     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
11357 
11358   // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
11359   // create a built-in binary operator.
11360   if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
11361     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
11362 
11363   // Build an empty overload set.
11364   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
11365 
11366   // Add the candidates from the given function set.
11367   AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet);
11368 
11369   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
11370   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
11371 
11372   // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not
11373   // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->,
11374   // which don't get here).
11375   if (Opc != BO_Assign)
11376     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args,
11377                                          /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
11378                                          CandidateSet);
11379 
11380   // Add builtin operator candidates.
11381   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
11382 
11383   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11384 
11385   // Perform overload resolution.
11386   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11387   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
11388     case OR_Success: {
11389       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
11390       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
11391 
11392       if (FnDecl) {
11393         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
11394         // operator.
11395 
11396         // Convert the arguments.
11397         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
11398           // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
11399           CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
11400 
11401           ExprResult Arg1 =
11402             PerformCopyInitialization(
11403               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11404                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
11405               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
11406           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
11407             return ExprError();
11408 
11409           ExprResult Arg0 =
11410             PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
11411                                                 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11412           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
11413             return ExprError();
11414           Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
11415           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
11416         } else {
11417           // Convert the arguments.
11418           ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
11419             InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11420                                                    FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
11421             SourceLocation(), Args[0]);
11422           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
11423             return ExprError();
11424 
11425           ExprResult Arg1 =
11426             PerformCopyInitialization(
11427               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
11428                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
11429               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
11430           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
11431             return ExprError();
11432           Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
11433           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
11434         }
11435 
11436         // Build the actual expression node.
11437         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
11438                                                   Best->FoundDecl,
11439                                                   HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
11440         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11441           return ExprError();
11442 
11443         // Determine the result type.
11444         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
11445         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11446         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11447 
11448         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
11449           new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.get(),
11450                                             Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
11451                                             FPFeatures.fp_contract);
11452 
11453         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
11454                                 FnDecl))
11455           return ExprError();
11456 
11457         ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
11458         // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
11459         if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl))
11460           ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
11461 
11462         // Check for a self move.
11463         if (Op == OO_Equal)
11464           DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc);
11465 
11466         checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ArgsArray, isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc,
11467                   TheCall->getSourceRange(), VariadicDoesNotApply);
11468 
11469         return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
11470       } else {
11471         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
11472         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
11473         // operator node.
11474         ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
11475           PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
11476                                     Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
11477         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
11478           return ExprError();
11479         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
11480 
11481         ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
11482           PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
11483                                     Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
11484         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
11485           return ExprError();
11486         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
11487         break;
11488       }
11489     }
11490 
11491     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
11492       // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
11493       //   If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
11494       //   viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
11495       //   built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
11496       if (Opc == BO_Comma)
11497         break;
11498 
11499       // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
11500       // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
11501       // no overloaded assignment operator found
11502       ExprResult Result = ExprError();
11503       if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
11504           Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
11505         Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
11506              << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
11507              << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11508         if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) {
11509           Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete)
11510             << Args[0]->getType()
11511             << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11512         }
11513       } else {
11514         // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
11515         // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
11516         // defined too late to be candidates.
11517         if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
11518           // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
11519           return ExprError();
11520 
11521         // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
11522         // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
11523         Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
11524       }
11525       assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
11526              "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
11527       if (Result.isInvalid())
11528         CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
11529                                     BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
11530       return Result;
11531     }
11532 
11533     case OR_Ambiguous:
11534       Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
11535           << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
11536           << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
11537           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11538       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
11539                                   BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
11540       return ExprError();
11541 
11542     case OR_Deleted:
11543       if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
11544         CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
11545         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
11546           << Context.getRecordType(Method->getParent())
11547           << getSpecialMember(Method);
11548 
11549         // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
11550         // explain why it's deleted.
11551         NoteDeletedFunction(Method);
11552         return ExprError();
11553       } else {
11554         Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11555           << Best->Function->isDeleted()
11556           << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
11557           << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
11558           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11559       }
11560       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
11561                                   BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
11562       return ExprError();
11563   }
11564 
11565   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
11566   return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
11567 }
11568 
11569 ExprResult
11570 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
11571                                          SourceLocation RLoc,
11572                                          Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
11573   Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
11574   DeclarationName OpName =
11575       Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
11576 
11577   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
11578   // expression.
11579   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
11580 
11581     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
11582     // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
11583     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
11584     OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
11585     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
11586       = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
11587                                      NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
11588                                      /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
11589                                      UnresolvedSetIterator(),
11590                                      UnresolvedSetIterator());
11591     // Can't add any actual overloads yet
11592 
11593     return new (Context)
11594         CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn, Args,
11595                             Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc, false);
11596   }
11597 
11598   // Handle placeholders on both operands.
11599   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
11600     return ExprError();
11601   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
11602     return ExprError();
11603 
11604   // Build an empty overload set.
11605   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
11606 
11607   // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
11608 
11609   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
11610   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
11611 
11612   // Add builtin operator candidates.
11613   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
11614 
11615   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
11616 
11617   // Perform overload resolution.
11618   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11619   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
11620     case OR_Success: {
11621       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
11622       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
11623 
11624       if (FnDecl) {
11625         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
11626         // operator.
11627 
11628         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
11629 
11630         // Convert the arguments.
11631         CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
11632         ExprResult Arg0 =
11633           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
11634                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
11635         if (Arg0.isInvalid())
11636           return ExprError();
11637         Args[0] = Arg0.get();
11638 
11639         // Convert the arguments.
11640         ExprResult InputInit
11641           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
11642                                                       Context,
11643                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
11644                                       SourceLocation(),
11645                                       Args[1]);
11646         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
11647           return ExprError();
11648 
11649         Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
11650 
11651         // Build the actual expression node.
11652         DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
11653         OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
11654         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
11655                                                   Best->FoundDecl,
11656                                                   HadMultipleCandidates,
11657                                                   OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
11658                                                   OpLocInfo.getInfo());
11659         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
11660           return ExprError();
11661 
11662         // Determine the result type
11663         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
11664         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
11665         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11666 
11667         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
11668           new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
11669                                             FnExpr.get(), Args,
11670                                             ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
11671                                             false);
11672 
11673         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
11674           return ExprError();
11675 
11676         return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
11677       } else {
11678         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
11679         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
11680         // operator node.
11681         ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
11682           PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
11683                                     Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
11684         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
11685           return ExprError();
11686         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
11687 
11688         ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
11689           PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
11690                                     Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
11691         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
11692           return ExprError();
11693         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
11694 
11695         break;
11696       }
11697     }
11698 
11699     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
11700       if (CandidateSet.empty())
11701         Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
11702           << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
11703           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11704       else
11705         Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
11706           << Args[0]->getType()
11707           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11708       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
11709                                   "[]", LLoc);
11710       return ExprError();
11711     }
11712 
11713     case OR_Ambiguous:
11714       Diag(LLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
11715           << "[]"
11716           << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
11717           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11718       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args,
11719                                   "[]", LLoc);
11720       return ExprError();
11721 
11722     case OR_Deleted:
11723       Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
11724         << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
11725         << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
11726         << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
11727       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args,
11728                                   "[]", LLoc);
11729       return ExprError();
11730     }
11731 
11732   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
11733   return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
11734 }
11735 
11736 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
11737 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
11738 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
11739 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object
11740 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
11741 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
11742 /// member function.
11743 ExprResult
11744 Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
11745                                 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
11746                                 MultiExprArg Args,
11747                                 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
11748   assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
11749          MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
11750 
11751   // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
11752   // argument and the member function we're referring to.
11753   Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
11754 
11755   // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
11756   if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
11757     assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
11758     assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
11759 
11760     QualType fnType =
11761       op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11762 
11763     const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11764     QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
11765     ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType());
11766 
11767     // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
11768     // member function we're calling.
11769     Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
11770 
11771     QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
11772     if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
11773       objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
11774     Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
11775 
11776     Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
11777     difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
11778     difference.removeAddressSpace();
11779     if (difference) {
11780       std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
11781       Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
11782         << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
11783         << qualsString
11784         << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
11785     }
11786 
11787     CXXMemberCallExpr *call
11788       = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
11789                                         resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
11790 
11791     if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getLocStart(),
11792                             call, nullptr))
11793       return ExprError();
11794 
11795     if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc))
11796       return ExprError();
11797 
11798     if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto))
11799       return ExprError();
11800 
11801     return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
11802   }
11803 
11804   if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr))
11805     return new (Context)
11806         CallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc);
11807 
11808   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
11809   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
11810     return ExprError();
11811 
11812   MemberExpr *MemExpr;
11813   CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr;
11814   DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public);
11815   NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr;
11816   if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
11817     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
11818     Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
11819     FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
11820     Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
11821     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11822   } else {
11823     UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
11824     Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
11825 
11826     QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
11827     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
11828       = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
11829                             : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
11830 
11831     // Add overload candidates
11832     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11833                                       OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
11834 
11835     // FIXME: avoid copy.
11836     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
11837     if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11838       UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
11839       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
11840     }
11841 
11842     for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
11843            E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
11844 
11845       NamedDecl *Func = *I;
11846       CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
11847       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
11848         Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
11849 
11850 
11851       // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
11852       if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
11853         AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(),
11854                              Args, CandidateSet);
11855       } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
11856         // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
11857         // non-template member function.
11858         if (TemplateArgs)
11859           continue;
11860 
11861         AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
11862                            ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
11863                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
11864       } else {
11865         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
11866                                    I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
11867                                    ObjectType,  ObjectClassification,
11868                                    Args, CandidateSet,
11869                                    /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
11870       }
11871     }
11872 
11873     DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
11874 
11875     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
11876 
11877     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
11878     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
11879                                             Best)) {
11880     case OR_Success:
11881       Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
11882       FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
11883       CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
11884       if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
11885         return ExprError();
11886       // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template
11887       // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
11888       // called on both.
11889       // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
11890       // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
11891       // being used.
11892       if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
11893                       DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
11894         return ExprError();
11895       break;
11896 
11897     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
11898       Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11899            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
11900         << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
11901       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11902       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
11903       return ExprError();
11904 
11905     case OR_Ambiguous:
11906       Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
11907         << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
11908       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11909       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
11910       return ExprError();
11911 
11912     case OR_Deleted:
11913       Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
11914         << Best->Function->isDeleted()
11915         << DeclName
11916         << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
11917         << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
11918       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
11919       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
11920       return ExprError();
11921     }
11922 
11923     MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
11924 
11925     // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
11926     // non-member call based on that function.
11927     if (Method->isStatic()) {
11928       return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args,
11929                                    RParenLoc);
11930     }
11931 
11932     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
11933   }
11934 
11935   QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType();
11936   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
11937   ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
11938 
11939   assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
11940   CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
11941     new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args,
11942                                     ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
11943 
11944   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
11945   if (getLangOpts().CUDA) {
11946     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) {
11947       if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Method)) {
11948         Diag(MemExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ref_bad_target)
11949             << IdentifyCUDATarget(Method) << Method->getIdentifier()
11950             << IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller);
11951         return ExprError();
11952       }
11953     }
11954   }
11955 
11956   // Check for a valid return type.
11957   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
11958                           TheCall, Method))
11959     return ExprError();
11960 
11961   // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
11962   // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
11963   // it was done at lookup.
11964   if (!Method->isStatic()) {
11965     ExprResult ObjectArg =
11966       PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
11967                                           FoundDecl, Method);
11968     if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
11969       return ExprError();
11970     MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get());
11971   }
11972 
11973   // Convert the rest of the arguments
11974   const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
11975     Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11976   if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args,
11977                               RParenLoc))
11978     return ExprError();
11979 
11980   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
11981 
11982   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
11983     return ExprError();
11984 
11985   // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading
11986   // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do
11987   // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors
11988   if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
11989     if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = CheckEnableIf(Method, Args, true)) {
11990       Diag(MemExprE->getLocStart(),
11991            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
11992           << Method << Method->getSourceRange();
11993       Diag(Method->getLocation(),
11994            diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr)
11995           << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
11996       return ExprError();
11997     }
11998   }
11999 
12000   if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
12001        isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
12002       TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
12003     const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
12004 
12005     if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) &&
12006         MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) {
12007       Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
12008            diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
12009         << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
12010         << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
12011 
12012       Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
12013       if (getLangOpts().AppleKext)
12014         Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
12015              diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext)
12016              << MD->getParent()->getDeclName()
12017              << MD->getDeclName();
12018     }
12019   }
12020   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
12021 }
12022 
12023 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
12024 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
12025 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
12026 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
12027 ExprResult
12028 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
12029                                    SourceLocation LParenLoc,
12030                                    MultiExprArg Args,
12031                                    SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
12032   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
12033     return ExprError();
12034   ExprResult Object = Obj;
12035 
12036   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
12037   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
12038     return ExprError();
12039 
12040   assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() &&
12041          "Requires object type argument");
12042   const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
12043 
12044   // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
12045   //  If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
12046   //  evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
12047   //  candidate functions includes at least the function call
12048   //  operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
12049   //  ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
12050   //  (E).operator().
12051   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc,
12052                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
12053   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
12054 
12055   if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
12056                           diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
12057     return true;
12058 
12059   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
12060   LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
12061   R.suppressDiagnostics();
12062 
12063   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
12064        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
12065     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
12066                        Object.get()->Classify(Context),
12067                        Args, CandidateSet,
12068                        /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
12069   }
12070 
12071   // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
12072   //   In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
12073   //   declared in T of the form
12074   //
12075   //        operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
12076   //
12077   //   where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
12078   //   greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
12079   //   denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
12080   //   R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
12081   //   (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
12082   //   of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
12083   //   is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
12084   //   surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
12085   //   functions for each conversion function declared in an
12086   //   accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
12087   //   within T by another intervening declaration.
12088   const auto &Conversions =
12089       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
12090   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
12091     NamedDecl *D = *I;
12092     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
12093     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
12094       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
12095 
12096     // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
12097     // surrogates.
12098     if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
12099       continue;
12100 
12101     CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
12102     if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
12103       // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
12104       // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
12105       QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
12106       if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
12107         ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
12108 
12109       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
12110       {
12111         AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
12112                               Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet);
12113       }
12114     }
12115   }
12116 
12117   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
12118 
12119   // Perform overload resolution.
12120   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12121   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
12122                              Best)) {
12123   case OR_Success:
12124     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
12125     // below.
12126     break;
12127 
12128   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
12129     if (CandidateSet.empty())
12130       Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
12131         << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
12132         << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
12133     else
12134       Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
12135            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
12136         << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
12137     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
12138     break;
12139 
12140   case OR_Ambiguous:
12141     Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
12142          diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
12143       << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
12144     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
12145     break;
12146 
12147   case OR_Deleted:
12148     Diag(Object.get()->getLocStart(),
12149          diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
12150       << Best->Function->isDeleted()
12151       << Object.get()->getType()
12152       << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
12153       << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
12154     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
12155     break;
12156   }
12157 
12158   if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
12159     return true;
12160 
12161   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
12162 
12163   if (Best->Function == nullptr) {
12164     // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
12165     // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
12166     CXXConversionDecl *Conv
12167       = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
12168                          Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
12169 
12170     CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr,
12171                               Best->FoundDecl);
12172     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc))
12173       return ExprError();
12174     assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
12175              "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!");
12176     // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
12177     // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
12178     // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
12179 
12180     // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
12181     // and then call it.
12182     ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
12183                                              Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
12184     if (Call.isInvalid())
12185       return ExprError();
12186     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
12187     Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, Call.get()->getType(),
12188                                     CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(),
12189                                     nullptr, VK_RValue);
12190 
12191     return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc);
12192   }
12193 
12194   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
12195 
12196   // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
12197   // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
12198   // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
12199   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
12200 
12201   // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
12202   if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
12203     return ExprError();
12204 
12205   const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
12206     Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
12207 
12208   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
12209 
12210   DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
12211                Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
12212   OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
12213   ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
12214                                            HadMultipleCandidates,
12215                                            OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
12216                                            OpLocInfo.getInfo());
12217   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
12218     return true;
12219 
12220   // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object
12221   // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list).
12222   std::unique_ptr<Expr * []> MethodArgs(new Expr *[Args.size() + 1]);
12223   MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
12224   std::copy(Args.begin(), Args.end(), &MethodArgs[1]);
12225 
12226   // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
12227   // owned.
12228   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
12229   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
12230   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
12231 
12232   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = new (Context)
12233       CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(),
12234                           llvm::makeArrayRef(MethodArgs.get(), Args.size() + 1),
12235                           ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc, false);
12236   MethodArgs.reset();
12237 
12238   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method))
12239     return true;
12240 
12241   // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
12242   // slots in the call for them.
12243   if (Args.size() < NumParams)
12244     TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumParams + 1);
12245 
12246   bool IsError = false;
12247 
12248   // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
12249   ExprResult ObjRes =
12250     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
12251                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
12252   if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
12253     IsError = true;
12254   else
12255     Object = ObjRes;
12256   TheCall->setArg(0, Object.get());
12257 
12258   // Check the argument types.
12259   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) {
12260     Expr *Arg;
12261     if (i < Args.size()) {
12262       Arg = Args[i];
12263 
12264       // Pass the argument.
12265 
12266       ExprResult InputInit
12267         = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
12268                                                     Context,
12269                                                     Method->getParamDecl(i)),
12270                                     SourceLocation(), Arg);
12271 
12272       IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
12273       Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
12274     } else {
12275       ExprResult DefArg
12276         = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
12277       if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
12278         IsError = true;
12279         break;
12280       }
12281 
12282       Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>();
12283     }
12284 
12285     TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
12286   }
12287 
12288   // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
12289   if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
12290     // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
12291     for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) {
12292       ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
12293                                                         nullptr);
12294       IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
12295       TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.get());
12296     }
12297   }
12298 
12299   if (IsError) return true;
12300 
12301   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
12302 
12303   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
12304     return true;
12305 
12306   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
12307 }
12308 
12309 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
12310 ///  (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
12311 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
12312 ExprResult
12313 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc,
12314                                bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) {
12315   assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
12316          "left-hand side must have class type");
12317 
12318   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
12319     return ExprError();
12320 
12321   SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
12322 
12323   // C++ [over.ref]p1:
12324   //
12325   //   [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
12326   //   for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
12327   //   the operator is selected as the best match function by the
12328   //   overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
12329   DeclarationName OpName =
12330     Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
12331   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
12332   const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
12333 
12334   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
12335                           diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
12336     return ExprError();
12337 
12338   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
12339   LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
12340   R.suppressDiagnostics();
12341 
12342   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
12343        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
12344     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
12345                        None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
12346   }
12347 
12348   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
12349 
12350   // Perform overload resolution.
12351   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12352   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
12353   case OR_Success:
12354     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
12355     break;
12356 
12357   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
12358     if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
12359       QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
12360       if (NoArrowOperatorFound) {
12361         // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a
12362         // diagnostic, as requested.
12363         *NoArrowOperatorFound = true;
12364         return ExprError();
12365       }
12366       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
12367         << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange();
12368       if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) {
12369         Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
12370           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
12371       }
12372     } else
12373       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
12374         << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
12375     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
12376     return ExprError();
12377 
12378   case OR_Ambiguous:
12379     Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
12380       << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
12381     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Base);
12382     return ExprError();
12383 
12384   case OR_Deleted:
12385     Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
12386       << Best->Function->isDeleted()
12387       << "->"
12388       << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
12389       << Base->getSourceRange();
12390     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
12391     return ExprError();
12392   }
12393 
12394   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
12395 
12396   // Convert the object parameter.
12397   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
12398   ExprResult BaseResult =
12399     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
12400                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
12401   if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
12402     return ExprError();
12403   Base = BaseResult.get();
12404 
12405   // Build the operator call.
12406   ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
12407                                             HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
12408   if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
12409     return ExprError();
12410 
12411   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
12412   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
12413   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
12414   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
12415     new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(),
12416                                       Base, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, false);
12417 
12418   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method))
12419           return ExprError();
12420 
12421   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
12422 }
12423 
12424 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
12425 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
12426 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
12427                                           DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
12428                                           ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
12429                                           SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
12430                                        TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
12431   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
12432 
12433   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc,
12434                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
12435   AddFunctionCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet, TemplateArgs,
12436                         /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true);
12437 
12438   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
12439 
12440   // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
12441   // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
12442   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12443   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
12444   case OR_Success:
12445   case OR_Deleted:
12446     break;
12447 
12448   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
12449     Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
12450       << R.getLookupName();
12451     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
12452     return ExprError();
12453 
12454   case OR_Ambiguous:
12455     Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call) << R.getLookupName();
12456     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args);
12457     return ExprError();
12458   }
12459 
12460   FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
12461   ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
12462                                         HadMultipleCandidates,
12463                                         SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
12464                                         SuffixInfo.getInfo());
12465   if (Fn.isInvalid())
12466     return true;
12467 
12468   // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
12469   // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
12470   Expr *ConvArgs[2];
12471   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
12472     ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
12473       InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
12474       SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
12475     if (InputInit.isInvalid())
12476       return true;
12477     ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get();
12478   }
12479 
12480   QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType();
12481   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
12482   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
12483 
12484   UserDefinedLiteral *UDL =
12485     new (Context) UserDefinedLiteral(Context, Fn.get(),
12486                                      llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()),
12487                                      ResultTy, VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc);
12488 
12489   if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
12490     return ExprError();
12491 
12492   if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr))
12493     return ExprError();
12494 
12495   return MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL);
12496 }
12497 
12498 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
12499 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
12500 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
12501 /// dependent lookup.
12502 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
12503 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
12504 /// is returned.
12505 Sema::ForRangeStatus
12506 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc,
12507                                 SourceLocation RangeLoc,
12508                                 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
12509                                 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
12510                                 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
12511                                 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
12512   Scope *S = nullptr;
12513 
12514   CandidateSet->clear();
12515   if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
12516     ExprResult MemberRef =
12517         BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
12518                                  /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
12519                                  /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
12520                                  /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr,
12521                                  MemberLookup,
12522                                  /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S);
12523     if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
12524       *CallExpr = ExprError();
12525       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
12526     }
12527     *CallExpr = ActOnCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr);
12528     if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
12529       *CallExpr = ExprError();
12530       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
12531     }
12532   } else {
12533     UnresolvedSet<0> FoundNames;
12534     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn =
12535       UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, /*NamingClass=*/nullptr,
12536                                    NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), NameInfo,
12537                                    /*NeedsADL=*/true, /*Overloaded=*/false,
12538                                    FoundNames.begin(), FoundNames.end());
12539 
12540     bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc,
12541                                                     CandidateSet, CallExpr);
12542     if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
12543       *CallExpr = ExprError();
12544       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
12545     }
12546     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12547     OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
12548         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best);
12549 
12550     if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
12551       *CallExpr = ExprError();
12552       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
12553     }
12554     *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range,
12555                                          Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best,
12556                                          OverloadResult,
12557                                          /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
12558     if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
12559       *CallExpr = ExprError();
12560       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
12561     }
12562   }
12563   return FRS_Success;
12564 }
12565 
12566 
12567 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
12568 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
12569 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
12570 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
12571 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
12572 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
12573                                            FunctionDecl *Fn) {
12574   if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
12575     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
12576                                                    Found, Fn);
12577     if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
12578       return PE;
12579 
12580     return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
12581   }
12582 
12583   if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
12584     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
12585                                                    Found, Fn);
12586     assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
12587                                SubExpr->getType()) &&
12588            "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
12589     assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
12590     if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
12591       return ICE;
12592 
12593     return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
12594                                     ICE->getCastKind(),
12595                                     SubExpr, nullptr,
12596                                     ICE->getValueKind());
12597   }
12598 
12599   if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
12600     assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
12601            "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
12602     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
12603       if (Method->isStatic()) {
12604         // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
12605         // from non-member functions.
12606       } else {
12607         // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an
12608         // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
12609         // or template.
12610         Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
12611                                                        Found, Fn);
12612         if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
12613           return UnOp;
12614 
12615         assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
12616                && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
12617         assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
12618                && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
12619 
12620         // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
12621         // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
12622         // appropriate pointer to member type.
12623         QualType ClassType
12624           = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
12625         QualType MemPtrType
12626           = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
12627 
12628         return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
12629                                            VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
12630                                            UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
12631       }
12632     }
12633     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
12634                                                    Found, Fn);
12635     if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
12636       return UnOp;
12637 
12638     return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
12639                                      Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
12640                                        VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
12641                                        UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
12642   }
12643 
12644   if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
12645     // FIXME: avoid copy.
12646     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
12647     if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12648       ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
12649       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
12650     }
12651 
12652     DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
12653                                            ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
12654                                            ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
12655                                            Fn,
12656                                            /*enclosing*/ false, // FIXME?
12657                                            ULE->getNameLoc(),
12658                                            Fn->getType(),
12659                                            VK_LValue,
12660                                            Found.getDecl(),
12661                                            TemplateArgs);
12662     MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
12663     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
12664     return DRE;
12665   }
12666 
12667   if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
12668     // FIXME: avoid copy.
12669     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
12670     if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12671       MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
12672       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
12673     }
12674 
12675     Expr *Base;
12676 
12677     // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
12678     // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
12679     if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
12680       if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
12681         DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
12682                                                MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
12683                                                MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(),
12684                                                Fn,
12685                                                /*enclosing*/ false,
12686                                                MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
12687                                                Fn->getType(),
12688                                                VK_LValue,
12689                                                Found.getDecl(),
12690                                                TemplateArgs);
12691         MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE);
12692         DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
12693         return DRE;
12694       } else {
12695         SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
12696         if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
12697           Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
12698         CheckCXXThisCapture(Loc);
12699         Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
12700                                          MemExpr->getBaseType(),
12701                                          /*isImplicit=*/true);
12702       }
12703     } else
12704       Base = MemExpr->getBase();
12705 
12706     ExprValueKind valueKind;
12707     QualType type;
12708     if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
12709       valueKind = VK_LValue;
12710       type = Fn->getType();
12711     } else {
12712       valueKind = VK_RValue;
12713       type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
12714     }
12715 
12716     MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(
12717         Context, Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(),
12718         MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found,
12719         MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(), TemplateArgs, type, valueKind,
12720         OK_Ordinary);
12721     ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
12722     MarkMemberReferenced(ME);
12723     return ME;
12724   }
12725 
12726   llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
12727 }
12728 
12729 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
12730                                                 DeclAccessPair Found,
12731                                                 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
12732   return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn);
12733 }
12734